blob: e1e9810b42952b448abb516865390e18a62eed7d [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreaufba74ea2018-12-22 11:19:45 +01005 version 2.0
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreauefac87e2019-11-15 17:26:16 +01007 2019/11/15
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020025 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100341.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100371.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
442.4. Time format
452.5. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200533.6. Mailers
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +0200543.7. Programs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020055
564. Proxies
574.1. Proxy keywords matrix
584.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
59
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100605. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200615.1. Bind options
625.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200635.3. Server DNS resolution
645.3.1. Global overview
655.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020066
676. HTTP header manipulation
68
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200697. Using ACLs and fetching samples
707.1. ACL basics
717.1.1. Matching booleans
727.1.2. Matching integers
737.1.3. Matching strings
747.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
757.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
767.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
777.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
787.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200797.3.1. Converters
807.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
817.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
827.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
837.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
847.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200857.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020086
878. Logging
888.1. Log levels
898.2. Log formats
908.2.1. Default log format
918.2.2. TCP log format
928.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100938.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +0100948.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200958.3. Advanced logging options
968.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
978.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
988.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
998.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
1008.4. Timing events
1018.5. Session state at disconnection
1028.6. Non-printable characters
1038.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1048.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1058.9. Examples of logs
106
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001079. Supported filters
1089.1. Trace
1099.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001109.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +01001119.4. Cache
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200112
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010011310. Cache
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +010011410.1. Limitation
11510.2. Setup
11610.2.1. Cache section
11710.2.2. Proxy section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200118
1191. Quick reminder about HTTP
120----------------------------
121
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100122When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200123fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
124on almost anything found in the contents.
125
126However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
127formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
128correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
129
130
1311.1. The HTTP transaction model
132-------------------------------
133
134The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100135to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100136from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
137connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200138will involve a new connection :
139
140 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
141
142In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
143establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
144by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
145length.
146
147Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
148to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
149however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
150response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
151header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
152
153 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
154
155Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
156power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
157but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200158a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200159
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100160Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200161keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
162second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
163page :
164
165 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
166
167This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
168latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
169correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
170the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100171server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200172
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100173The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2. This
174time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all streams
175are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
176parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
177carry the stream identifier.
178
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100179By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
180connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
181leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100182start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
183processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
184waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200185
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200186HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100187 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
188 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +0100189 everything else is forwarded with no analysis (deprecated).
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100190 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200191 - close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100192
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100193For HTTP/2, the connection mode resembles more the "server close" mode : given
194the independence of all streams, there is currently no place to hook the idle
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100195server connection after a response, so it is closed after the response. HTTP/2
196is only supported for incoming connections, not on connections going to
197servers.
198
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200199
2001.2. HTTP request
201-----------------
202
203First, let's consider this HTTP request :
204
205 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100206 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200207 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
208 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
209 3 User-agent: my small browser
210 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
211 5 Accept: image/png
212
213
2141.2.1. The Request line
215-----------------------
216
217Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
218
219 - a METHOD : GET
220 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
221 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
222
223All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
224which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
225followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
226is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
227desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
228the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
229
230The URI itself can have several forms :
231
232 - A "relative URI" :
233
234 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
235
236 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
237 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
238
239 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
240
241 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
242
243 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
244 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
245 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
246 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
247 must accept this form too.
248
249 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
250 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
251 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100252
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200253 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
254 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
255 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
256 other protocols too.
257
258In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
259mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
260on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
261It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
262specific to the language, framework or application in use.
263
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100264HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100265assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100266However, haproxy natively processes HTTP/1.x requests and headers, so requests
267received over an HTTP/2 connection are transcoded to HTTP/1.1 before being
268processed. This explains why they still appear as "HTTP/1.1" in haproxy's logs
269as well as in server logs.
270
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200271
2721.2.2. The request headers
273--------------------------
274
275The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
276beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
277an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
278Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
279values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
280encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
281the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
282define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
283
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100284Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200285their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100286"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
287as can be seen when running in debug mode.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200288
289The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
290that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
291is one valid form of empty line.
292
293Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
294headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
295about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
296application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
297
298Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000299 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200300 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
301 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
302 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
303
304
3051.3. HTTP response
306------------------
307
308An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
309messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
310
311 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100312 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200313 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
314 2 Content-length: 350
315 3 Content-Type: text/html
316
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200317As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
318codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
319response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100320continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
321the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
322following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
323sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
324(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
325correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
326such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
327state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
328over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
329if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
330information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200331
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200332
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003331.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200334------------------------
335
336Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
337
338 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
339 - a status code : 200
340 - a reason : OK
341
342The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100343 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
344 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
345 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
346 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
347 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200348
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000349Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100350"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200351found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
352messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
353or "Authentication Required".
354
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100355HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200356
357 Code When / reason
358 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
359 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
360 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
361 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100362 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
363 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200364 400 for an invalid or too large request
365 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
366 accessing the stats page)
367 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
368 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
369 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
370 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
371 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
372 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
373 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
374 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
375 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
376
377The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3784.2).
379
380
3811.3.2. The response headers
382---------------------------
383
384Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
385the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
386details.
387
388
3892. Configuring HAProxy
390----------------------
391
3922.1. Configuration file format
393------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200394
395HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
396
397 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
398 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
399 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
400 "frontend" and "backend".
401
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100402The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
403referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200404delimited by spaces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100405
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200406
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02004072.2. Quoting and escaping
408-------------------------
409
410HAProxy's configuration introduces a quoting and escaping system similar to
411many programming languages. The configuration file supports 3 types: escaping
412with a backslash, weak quoting with double quotes, and strong quoting with
413single quotes.
414
415If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be escaped by preceding
416them by a backslash ('\') or by quoting them. Backslashes also have to be
417escaped by doubling or strong quoting them.
418
419Escaping is achieved by preceding a special character by a backslash ('\'):
420
421 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
422 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
423 \\ to use a backslash
424 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
425 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
426
427Weak quoting is achieved by using double quotes (""). Weak quoting prevents
428the interpretation of:
429
430 space as a parameter separator
431 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
432 # hash as a comment start
433
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200434Weak quoting permits the interpretation of variables, if you want to use a non
435-interpreted dollar within a double quoted string, you should escape it with a
436backslash ("\$"), it does not work outside weak quoting.
437
438Interpretation of escaping and special characters are not prevented by weak
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200439quoting.
440
441Strong quoting is achieved by using single quotes (''). Inside single quotes,
442nothing is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regexes.
443
444Quoted and escaped strings are replaced in memory by their interpreted
445equivalent, it allows you to perform concatenation.
446
447 Example:
448 # those are equivalents:
449 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
450 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
451 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
452 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
453 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
454
455 # those are equivalents:
456 reqrep "^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" \1\ /\2
457 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" '\1 /\2'
458 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1 /\2"
459 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1\ /\2"
460
461
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004622.3. Environment variables
463--------------------------
464
465HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
466interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
467configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
468optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
469shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
470underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit.
471
472 Example:
473
474 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
475
476 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
477
478 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
479
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200480Some variables are defined by HAProxy, they can be used in the configuration
481file, or could be inherited by a program (See 3.7. Programs):
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200482
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200483* HAPROXY_LOCALPEER: defined at the startup of the process which contains the
484 name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
485
486* HAPROXY_CFGFILES: list of the configuration files loaded by HAProxy,
487 separated by semicolons. Can be useful in the case you specified a
488 directory.
489
490* HAPROXY_MWORKER: In master-worker mode, this variable is set to 1.
491
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500492* HAPROXY_CLI: configured listeners addresses of the stats socket for every
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200493 processes, separated by semicolons.
494
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500495* HAPROXY_MASTER_CLI: In master-worker mode, listeners addresses of the master
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200496 CLI, separated by semicolons.
497
498See also "external-check command" for other variables.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200499
5002.4. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200501----------------
502
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100503Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100504values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
505otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
506numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
507for every keyword. Supported units are :
508
509 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
510 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
511 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
512 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
513 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
514 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
515
516
Lukas Tribusaa83a312017-03-21 09:25:09 +00005172.5. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200518-------------
519
520 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
521 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
522 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
523 global
524 daemon
525 maxconn 256
526
527 defaults
528 mode http
529 timeout connect 5000ms
530 timeout client 50000ms
531 timeout server 50000ms
532
533 frontend http-in
534 bind *:80
535 default_backend servers
536
537 backend servers
538 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
539
540
541 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
542 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
543 global
544 daemon
545 maxconn 256
546
547 defaults
548 mode http
549 timeout connect 5000ms
550 timeout client 50000ms
551 timeout server 50000ms
552
553 listen http-in
554 bind *:80
555 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
556
557
558Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
559
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100560 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200561
562
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005633. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200564--------------------
565
566Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
567are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
568of them have command-line equivalents.
569
570The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
571
572 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200573 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200574 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200575 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200576 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200577 - daemon
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200578 - description
579 - deviceatlas-json-file
580 - deviceatlas-log-level
581 - deviceatlas-separator
582 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900583 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200584 - gid
585 - group
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100586 - hard-stop-after
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200587 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200588 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100589 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200590 - lua-load
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +0200591 - mworker-max-reloads
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200592 - nbproc
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200593 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200594 - node
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200595 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100596 - presetenv
597 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200598 - uid
599 - ulimit-n
600 - user
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +0200601 - set-dumpable
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100602 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200603 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200604 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200605 - ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200606 - ssl-default-bind-options
607 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200608 - ssl-default-server-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200609 - ssl-default-server-options
610 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100611 - ssl-server-verify
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100612 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100613 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100614 - 51degrees-data-file
615 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200616 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200617 - 51degrees-cache-size
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200618 - wurfl-data-file
619 - wurfl-information-list
620 - wurfl-information-list-separator
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200621 - wurfl-cache-size
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100622
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200623 * Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200624 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200625 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200626 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100627 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100628 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100629 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200630 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200631 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200632 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200633 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200634 - noepoll
635 - nokqueue
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +0000636 - noevports
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200637 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100638 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300639 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +0000640 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +0100641 - profiling.tasks
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200642 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200643 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200644 - server-state-file
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +0000645 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +0000646 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200647 - tune.buffers.limit
648 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200649 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200650 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100651 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +0200652 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +0200653 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +0200654 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100655 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +0200656 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200657 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100658 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100659 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +0100660 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100661 - tune.lua.session-timeout
662 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +0200663 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100664 - tune.maxaccept
665 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200666 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +0200667 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200668 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100669 - tune.rcvbuf.client
670 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +0100671 - tune.recv_enough
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +0200672 - tune.runqueue-depth
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100673 - tune.sndbuf.client
674 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100675 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100676 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200677 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100678 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200679 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +0200680 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +0100681 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200682 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +0100683 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200684 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
685 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
686 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100687 - tune.zlib.memlevel
688 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100689
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200690 * Debugging
691 - debug
692 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200693
694
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006953.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200696------------------------------------
697
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200698ca-base <dir>
699 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200700 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
701 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200702
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200703chroot <jail dir>
704 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
705 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
706 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
707 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
708 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100709 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100710
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100711cpu-map [auto:]<process-set>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>...
712 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process or a thread to a
713 specific CPU set. This means that the process or the thread will never run on
714 other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for process or thread
715 sets. The first argument is a process set, eventually followed by a thread
716 set. These sets have the format
717
718 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
719
720 <number>> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100721 word size. Any process IDs above nbproc and any thread IDs above nbthread are
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100722 ignored. It is possible to specify a range with two such number delimited by
723 a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all processes at once using
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100724 "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like
725 with the "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100726 CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100727 range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100728 or ranges may be specified, and the processes or threads will be allowed to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100729 bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100730 specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace the previous ones when they
731 overlap. A thread will be bound on the intersection of its mapping and the
732 one of the process on which it is attached. If the intersection is null, no
733 specific binding will be set for the thread.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100734
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +0100735 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
736 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
737 on the machine's word size.
738
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100739 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the process set to let HAProxy
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100740 automatically bind a process or a thread to a CPU by incrementing
741 process/thread and CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same
742 size. No matter the declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from
743 the lowest to the highest bound. Having a process and a thread range with the
744 "auto:" prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one
745 must be a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100746
747 Examples:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100748 cpu-map 1-4 0-3 # bind processes 1 to 4 on the first 4 CPUs
749
750 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first process on the
751 # first 4 CPUs
752
753 cpu-map 1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1-64 0-63"
754 # or "cpu-map 1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
755 # word size.
756
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100757 # all these lines bind the process 1 to the cpu 0, the process 2 to cpu 1
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100758 # and so on.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100759 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-3
760 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-1 2-3
761 cpu-map auto:1-4 3 2 1 0
762
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100763 # all these lines bind the thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
764 # and so on.
765 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
766 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
767 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
768
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100769 # bind each process to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100770 cpu-map auto:all 0-63
771 cpu-map auto:even 0-31
772 cpu-map auto:odd 32-63
773
774 # invalid cpu-map because process and CPU sets have different sizes.
775 cpu-map auto:1-4 0 # invalid
776 cpu-map auto:1 0-3 # invalid
777
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100778 # invalid cpu-map because automatic binding is used with a process range
779 # and a thread range.
780 cpu-map auto:all/all 0 # invalid
781 cpu-map auto:all/1-4 0 # invalid
782 cpu-map auto:1-4/all 0 # invalid
783
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200784crt-base <dir>
785 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
786 path is used with "crtfile" directives. Absolute locations specified after
787 "crtfile" prevail and ignore "crt-base".
788
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200789daemon
790 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
791 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +0100792 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
793 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200794
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200795deviceatlas-json-file <path>
796 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100797 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200798
799deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100800 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200801 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
802
803deviceatlas-separator <char>
804 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
805 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
806
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +0100807deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200808 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
809 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
810 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +0100811
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900812external-check
813 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks.
814 This is disabled by default as a security precaution.
815 See "option external-check".
816
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200817gid <number>
818 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
819 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
820 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100821 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
822 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200823 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100824
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100825hard-stop-after <time>
826 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
827
828 Arguments :
829 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
830 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
831 SIGUSR1 signal.
832
833 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
834 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
835 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
836
837 Example:
838 global
839 hard-stop-after 30s
840
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200841group <group name>
842 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
843 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100844
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +0200845log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
846 <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +0100847 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100848 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100849 configured with "log global".
850
851 <address> can be one of:
852
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100853 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100854 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
855 port).
856
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100857 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
858 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
859 port).
860
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100861 - A filesystem path to a datagram UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100862 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
863 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100864 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100865
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100866 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may point
867 to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered logs are used
868 and one writev() call per log is performed. This is a bit expensive
869 but acceptable for most workloads. Messages sent this way will not be
870 truncated but may be dropped, in which case the DroppedLogs counter
871 will be incremented. The writev() call is atomic even on pipes for
872 messages up to PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least
873 512 and which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
874 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other processes.
875 Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file descriptor may also be
876 directed to a file, but doing so will significantly slow haproxy down
877 as non-blocking calls will be ignored. Also there will be no way to
878 purge nor rotate this file without restarting the process. Note that
879 the configured syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +0100880 for use with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
881 format below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100882
883 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1" and
884 "fd@2", see above.
885
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200886 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
887 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +0100888
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200889 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
890 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
891 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
892 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
893 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
894 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
895 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
896 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
897 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
898 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100899 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
900 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200901
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +0200902 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
903 one of the following :
904
905 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
906 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
907
908 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
909 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
910
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +0100911 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
912 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
913 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
914 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
915 logger consumes.
916
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +0100917 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
918 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
919 used in containers or during development, where the severity only
920 depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
921
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +0200922 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
923 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
924 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
925 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must be
926 set with <sample_size> parameter.
927
928 <sample_size>
929 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
930 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
931 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
932 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
933 (see also <ranges> parameter).
934
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100935 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200936
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +0100937 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
938 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
939 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
940
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +0100941 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
942 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
943 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
944 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200945
946 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200947 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
948 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
949 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
950 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
951 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
952 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200953
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200954 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200955
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100956log-send-hostname [<string>]
957 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
958 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
959 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
960 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
961 the logs.
962
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000963log-tag <string>
964 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
965 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
966 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +0100967 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000968
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100969lua-load <file>
970 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file. This directive can be
971 used multiple times.
972
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +0100973master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +0200974 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
975 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
976 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100977 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +0200978 or daemon mode. It is recommended to use this mode with multiprocess and
979 systemd.
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +0100980 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
981 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
982 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
983 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
984 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +0200985
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +0100986 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +0200987
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +0200988mworker-max-reloads <number>
989 In master-worker mode, this option limits the number of time a worker can
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500990 survive to a reload. If the worker did not leave after a reload, once its
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +0200991 number of reloads is greater than this number, the worker will receive a
992 SIGTERM. This option helps to keep under control the number of workers.
993 See also "show proc" in the Management Guide.
994
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200995nbproc <number>
996 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
997 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
998 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +0100999 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. When set to a value
1000 larger than 1, threads are automatically disabled. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
Willy Tarreau1f672a82019-01-26 14:20:55 +01001001 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon" and
1002 "nbthread".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001003
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001004nbthread <number>
1005 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
Willy Tarreau26f6ae12019-02-02 12:56:15 +01001006 makes haproxy run on <number> threads. This is exclusive with "nbproc". While
1007 "nbproc" historically used to be the only way to use multiple processors, it
1008 also involved a number of shortcomings related to the lack of synchronization
1009 between processes (health-checks, peers, stick-tables, stats, ...) which do
1010 not affect threads. As such, any modern configuration is strongly encouraged
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001011 to migrate away from "nbproc" to "nbthread". "nbthread" also works when
1012 HAProxy is started in foreground. On some platforms supporting CPU affinity,
1013 when nbproc is not used, the default "nbthread" value is automatically set to
1014 the number of CPUs the process is bound to upon startup. This means that the
1015 thread count can easily be adjusted from the calling process using commands
1016 like "taskset" or "cpuset". Otherwise, this value defaults to 1. The default
1017 value is reported in the output of "haproxy -vv". See also "nbproc".
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001018
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001019pidfile <pidfile>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001020 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001021 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
1022 starting the process. See also "daemon".
1023
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001024presetenv <name> <value>
1025 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1026 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
1027 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
1028 and "unsetenv".
1029
1030resetenv [<name> ...]
1031 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
1032 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
1033 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
1034 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
1035 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
1036 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
1037 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
1038 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
1039
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001040stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001041 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
1042 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
1043 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
1044 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
1045 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
1046 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001047 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001048 word size (32 or 64). Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can
1049 be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum
1050 value. A better option consists in using the "process" setting of the "stats
1051 socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001052
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001053server-state-base <directory>
1054 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001055 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
1056 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001057
1058server-state-file <file>
1059 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
1060 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
1061 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
1062 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
1063 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
1064 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
1065 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
1066 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001067 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
1068 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001069
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001070setenv <name> <value>
1071 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1072 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
1073 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
1074 and "unsetenv".
1075
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001076set-dumpable
1077 This option is better left disabled by default and enabled only upon a
1078 developer's request. It has no impact on performance nor stability but will
1079 try hard to re-enable core dumps that were possibly disabled by file size
1080 limitations (ulimit -f), core size limitations (ulimit -c), or "dumpability"
1081 of a process after changing its UID/GID (such as /proc/sys/fs/suid_dumpable
1082 on Linux). Core dumps might still be limited by the current directory's
1083 permissions (check what directory the file is started from), the chroot
1084 directory's permission (it may be needed to temporarily disable the chroot
1085 directive or to move it to a dedicated writable location), or any other
1086 system-specific constraint. For example, some Linux flavours are notorious
1087 for replacing the default core file with a path to an executable not even
1088 installed on the system (check /proc/sys/kernel/core_pattern). Often, simply
1089 writing "core", "core.%p" or "/var/log/core/core.%p" addresses the issue.
1090 When trying to enable this option waiting for a rare issue to re-appear, it's
1091 often a good idea to first try to obtain such a dump by issuing, for example,
1092 "kill -11" to the haproxy process and verify that it leaves a core where
1093 expected when dying.
1094
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001095ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
1096 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1097 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001098 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 for all
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001099 "bind" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001100 is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1101 information and recommendations see e.g.
1102 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1103 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
1104 cipher configuration, please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites" keyword.
1105 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001106
1107ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1108 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1109 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
1110 describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated
1111 during the TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
1112 theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001113 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1114 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1115 "ssl-default-bind-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001116 information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001117
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001118ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
1119 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1120 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
1121 keyword to see available options.
1122
1123 Example:
1124 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02001125 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001126
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001127ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
1128 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
1129 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001130 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 with the server,
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001131 for all "server" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001132 the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1133 information and recommendations see e.g.
1134 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1135 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
1136 For TLSv1.3 cipher configuration, please check the
1137 "ssl-default-server-ciphersuites" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword
1138 for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001139
1140ssl-default-server-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1141 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1142 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default
1143 string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are negotiated during
1144 the TLSv1.3 handshake with the server, for all "server" lines which do not
1145 explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001146 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1147 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1148 "ssl-default-server-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword for
1149 more information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001150
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001151ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
1152 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1153 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
1154 keyword to see available options.
1155
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001156ssl-dh-param-file <file>
1157 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1158 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
1159 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001160 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001161 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001162 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
1163 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
1164 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
1165 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001166 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
1167 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
1168 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
1169
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001170ssl-server-verify [none|required]
1171 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
1172 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
1173 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
1174
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001175stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
1176 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
1177 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
1178 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02001179 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02001180 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02001181
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001182 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
1183 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
1184 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001185
1186stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
1187 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
1188 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01001189 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001190
1191stats maxconn <connections>
1192 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
1193 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
1194
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001195uid <number>
1196 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
1197 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1198 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
1199 one. See also "gid" and "user".
1200
1201ulimit-n <number>
1202 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
1203 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
1204 option.
1205
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001206unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
1207 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
1208
1209 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
1210 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
1211 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
1212 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
1213 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
1214 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
1215 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
1216 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
1217 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
1218 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
1219
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001220unsetenv [<name> ...]
1221 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
1222 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
1223 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
1224 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
1225 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
1226 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
1227 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
1228
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001229user <user name>
1230 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
1231 See also "uid" and "group".
1232
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02001233node <name>
1234 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
1235
1236 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
1237 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
1238 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
1239 traffic.
1240
1241description <text>
1242 Add a text that describes the instance.
1243
1244 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
1245 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
1246 "<" and ">" characters.
1247
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100124851degrees-data-file <file path>
1249 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001250 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001251
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001252 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001253 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1254
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +0000125551degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001256 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
1257 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
1258 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
1259
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001260 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001261 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1262
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200126351degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001264 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
1265 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
1266
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001267 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
1268 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1269
127051degrees-cache-size <number>
1271 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
1272 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
1273 By default, this cache is disabled.
1274
1275 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001276 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1277
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001278wurfl-data-file <file path>
1279 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
1280 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
1281
1282 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1283 with USE_WURFL=1.
1284
1285wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
1286 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
1287 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
1288 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
1289
1290 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
1291
1292 Valid WURFL properties are:
1293 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
1294
1295 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
1296 device.
1297
1298 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
1299 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
1300
1301 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
1302 particular web request.
1303
1304 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
1305 used Libwurfl API version.
1306
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001307 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
1308 wurfl.xml and its full path.
1309
1310 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
1311 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
1312
1313 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
1314
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001315 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1316 with USE_WURFL=1.
1317
1318wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
1319 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
1320 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
1321
1322 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1323 with USE_WURFL=1.
1324
1325wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
1326 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
1327 thus before the chroot.
1328
1329 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1330 with USE_WURFL=1.
1331
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001332wurfl-cache-size <size>
1333 Sets the WURFL Useragent cache size. For faster lookups, already processed user
1334 agents are kept in a LRU cache :
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001335 - "0" : no cache is used.
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001336 - <size> : size of lru cache in elements.
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001337
1338 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1339 with USE_WURFL=1.
1340
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013413.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001342-----------------------
1343
Willy Tarreaubeb859a2018-11-22 18:07:59 +01001344busy-polling
1345 In some situations, especially when dealing with low latency on processors
1346 supporting a variable frequency or when running inside virtual machines, each
1347 time the process waits for an I/O using the poller, the processor goes back
1348 to sleep or is offered to another VM for a long time, and it causes
1349 excessively high latencies. This option provides a solution preventing the
1350 processor from sleeping by always using a null timeout on the pollers. This
1351 results in a significant latency reduction (30 to 100 microseconds observed)
1352 at the expense of a risk to overheat the processor. It may even be used with
1353 threads, in which case improperly bound threads may heavily conflict,
1354 resulting in a worse performance and high values for the CPU stolen fields
1355 in "show info" output, indicating which threads are misconfigured. It is
1356 important not to let the process run on the same processor as the network
1357 interrupts when this option is used. It is also better to avoid using it on
1358 multiple CPU threads sharing the same core. This option is disabled by
1359 default. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by
1360 prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It is ignored by the "select" and
1361 "poll" pollers.
1362
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001363max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
1364 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
1365 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
1366 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
1367 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
1368 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
1369 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
1370 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
1371 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
1372
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001373maxconn <number>
1374 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
1375 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
1376 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02001377 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
1378 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
1379 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
1380 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaub28f3442019-03-04 08:13:43 +01001381 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will automatically be
1382 calculated based on the current file descriptors limit reported by the
1383 "ulimit -n" command, possibly reduced to a lower value if a memory limit
1384 is enforced, based on the buffer size, memory allocated to compression, SSL
1385 cache size, and use or not of SSL and the associated maxsslconn (which can
1386 also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001387
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001388maxconnrate <number>
1389 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
1390 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1391 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1392 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1393 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1394 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1395 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1396 fairness.
1397
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001398maxcomprate <number>
1399 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001400 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001401 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
1402 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
1403 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001404 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001405 default value.
1406
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001407maxcompcpuusage <number>
1408 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
1409 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
1410 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
1411 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
1412 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
1413 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
1414 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
1415 process down and from introducing high latencies.
1416
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001417maxpipes <number>
1418 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
1419 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
1420 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
1421 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
1422 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
1423 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
1424
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001425maxsessrate <number>
1426 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
1427 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1428 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1429 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1430 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1431 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1432 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1433 fairness.
1434
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001435maxsslconn <number>
1436 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
1437 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
1438 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
1439 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
1440 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
1441 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
1442 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001443 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
1444 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
1445 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
1446 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
1447 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
1448 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
1449 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001450
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001451maxsslrate <number>
1452 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
1453 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
1454 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
1455 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
1456 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
1457 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
1458 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
1459 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
1460 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
1461 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
1462
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01001463maxzlibmem <number>
1464 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
1465 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
1466 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01001467 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
1468 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
1469 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
1470
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001471noepoll
1472 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
1473 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001474 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001475
1476nokqueue
1477 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
1478 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
1479 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
1480
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001481noevports
1482 Disables the use of the event ports event polling system on SunOS systems
1483 derived from Solaris 10 and later. It is equivalent to the command-line
1484 argument "-dv". The next polling system used will generally be "poll". See
1485 also "nopoll".
1486
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001487nopoll
1488 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
1489 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001490 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001491 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue", "noepoll" and
1492 "noevports".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001493
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001494nosplice
1495 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001496 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001497 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001498 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001499 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
1500 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
1501 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
1502 "option splice-response".
1503
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001504nogetaddrinfo
1505 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
1506 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
1507
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001508noreuseport
1509 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
1510 command line argument "-dR".
1511
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02001512profiling.tasks { auto | on | off }
1513 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-task CPU profiling. When set to 'auto'
1514 the profiling automatically turns on a thread when it starts to suffer from
1515 an average latency of 1000 microseconds or higher as reported in the
1516 "avg_loop_us" activity field, and automatically turns off when the latency
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001517 returns below 990 microseconds (this value is an average over the last 1024
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02001518 loops so it does not vary quickly and tends to significantly smooth short
1519 spikes). It may also spontaneously trigger from time to time on overloaded
1520 systems, containers, or virtual machines, or when the system swaps (which
1521 must absolutely never happen on a load balancer).
1522
1523 CPU profiling per task can be very convenient to report where the time is
1524 spent and which requests have what effect on which other request. Enabling
1525 it will typically affect the overall's performance by less than 1%, thus it
1526 is recommended to leave it to the default 'auto' value so that it only
1527 operates when a problem is identified. This feature requires a system
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01001528 supporting the clock_gettime(2) syscall with clock identifiers
1529 CLOCK_MONOTONIC and CLOCK_THREAD_CPUTIME_ID, otherwise the reported time will
1530 be zero. This option may be changed at run time using "set profiling" on the
1531 CLI.
1532
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001533spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09001534 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
1535 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
1536 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
1537 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
1538 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
1539 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001540
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001541ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001542 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001543 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001544 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
1545 unsupported engine will prevent haproxy from starting. Note that many engines
1546 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
1547 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
1548 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001549 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
1550 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001551 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
1552 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
1553 openssl configuration file uses:
1554 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
1555
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001556ssl-mode-async
1557 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02001558 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001559 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
1560 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
1561 haproxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001562 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and renegotiation
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001563 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001564
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001565tune.buffers.limit <number>
1566 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
1567 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
1568 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
1569 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
1570 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001571 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001572 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
1573 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
1574 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
1575 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
1576 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
1577 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
1578 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
1579 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
1580 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
1581
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01001582tune.buffers.reserve <number>
1583 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
1584 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
1585 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
1586 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
1587
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001588tune.bufsize <number>
1589 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
1590 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
1591 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
1592 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
1593 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
1594 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
1595 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01001596 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
1597 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
1598 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04001599 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
Willy Tarreauc77d3642018-12-12 06:19:42 +01001600 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway). Note that the
1601 value set using this parameter will automatically be rounded up to the next
1602 multiple of 8 on 32-bit machines and 16 on 64-bit machines.
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001603
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02001604tune.chksize <number>
1605 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
1606 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
1607 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
1608 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
1609 checks whenever possible.
1610
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001611tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
1612 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
1613 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
1614 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
1615 this value. The default value is 1.
1616
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01001617tune.fail-alloc
1618 If compiled with DEBUG_FAIL_ALLOC, gives the percentage of chances an
1619 allocation attempt fails. Must be between 0 (no failure) and 100 (no
1620 success). This is useful to debug and make sure memory failures are handled
1621 gracefully.
1622
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02001623tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
1624 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
1625 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
1626 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
1627 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
1628 change it.
1629
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001630tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
1631 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001632 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment from haproxy. This setting
1633 only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of POST requests), not headers.
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001634 The default value is 65535, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
1635 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
1636 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
1637 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
1638 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
1639
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02001640tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
1641 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
1642 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
1643 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
1644 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
1645 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
1646 client may create as many streams as allocatable by haproxy. It is highly
1647 recommended not to change this value.
1648
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01001649tune.h2.max-frame-size <number>
1650 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum frame size that haproxy announces it is willing to
1651 receive to its peers. The default value is the largest between 16384 and the
1652 buffer size (tune.bufsize). In any case, haproxy will not announce support
1653 for frame sizes larger than buffers. The main purpose of this setting is to
1654 allow to limit the maximum frame size setting when using large buffers. Too
1655 large frame sizes might have performance impact or cause some peers to
1656 misbehave. It is highly recommended not to change this value.
1657
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001658tune.http.cookielen <number>
1659 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
1660 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
1661 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
1662 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
1663 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
1664 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
1665 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
1666 to change this value.
1667
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001668tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001669 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
1670 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001671 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001672 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001673 configuration directives too.
1674 The default value is 1024.
1675
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001676tune.http.maxhdr <number>
1677 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
1678 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
1679 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
1680 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
1681 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
1682 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02001683 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
1684 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
1685 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001686
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001687tune.idletimer <timeout>
1688 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
1689 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
1690 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
1691 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
1692 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
1693 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001694 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001695 clicking). There should be no reason for changing this value. Please check
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001696 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
1697
Willy Tarreau7ac908b2019-02-27 12:02:18 +01001698tune.listener.multi-queue { on | off }
1699 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the listener's multi-queue accept which
1700 spreads the incoming traffic to all threads a "bind" line is allowed to run
1701 on instead of taking them for itself. This provides a smoother traffic
1702 distribution and scales much better, especially in environments where threads
1703 may be unevenly loaded due to external activity (network interrupts colliding
1704 with one thread for example). This option is enabled by default, but it may
1705 be forcefully disabled for troubleshooting or for situations where it is
1706 estimated that the operating system already provides a good enough
1707 distribution and connections are extremely short-lived.
1708
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001709tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
1710 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01001711 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001712 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
1713 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001714 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001715 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
1716 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
1717
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001718tune.lua.maxmem
1719 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
1720 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
1721 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
1722 memory.
1723
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001724tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
1725 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001726 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1727 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001728 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001729
1730tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
1731 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
1732 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
1733 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
1734 check servers.
1735
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001736tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
1737 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
1738 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1739 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001740 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001741
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001742tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01001743 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
1744 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
1745 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
1746 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
1747 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
1748 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
1749 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
1750 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
1751 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
1752 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001753
1754tune.maxpollevents <number>
1755 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
1756 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
1757 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
1758 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
1759 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
1760
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001761tune.maxrewrite <number>
1762 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
1763 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
1764 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
1765 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
1766 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
1767 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
1768 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
1769 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
1770 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
1771 bufsize.
1772
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001773tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
1774 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
1775 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
1776 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
1777 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
1778 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
1779 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
1780 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
1781 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
1782 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
Willy Tarreau7fdd81c2019-10-23 06:59:31 +02001783 about 5 MB per process/thread on 32-bit systems and 8 MB per process/thread
1784 on 64-bit systems, as caches are thread/process local. There is a very low
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001785 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
1786 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
1787 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
1788 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
1789 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
1790 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
1791 setting this parameter to 0.
1792
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001793tune.pipesize <number>
1794 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
1795 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
1796 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
1797 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
1798 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
1799 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
1800
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02001801tune.pool-low-fd-ratio <number>
1802 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
1803 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
1804 use before we stop putting connection into the idle pool for reuse. The
1805 default is 20.
1806
1807tune.pool-high-fd-ratio <number>
1808 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
1809 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
1810 use before we start killing idle connections when we can't reuse a connection
1811 and we have to create a new one. The default is 25 (one quarter of the file
1812 descriptor will mean that roughly half of the maximum front connections can
1813 keep an idle connection behind, anything beyond this probably doesn't make
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001814 much sense in the general case when targeting connection reuse).
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02001815
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001816tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
1817tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
1818 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
1819 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1820 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001821 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001822 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001823 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1824 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1825
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001826tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001827 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001828 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
1829 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
1830 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
1831 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
1832
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02001833tune.runqueue-depth <number>
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001834 Sets the maximum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02001835 tasks. The default value is 200. Increasing it may incur latency when
1836 dealing with I/Os, making it too small can incur extra overhead.
1837
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001838tune.sndbuf.client <number>
1839tune.sndbuf.server <number>
1840 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
1841 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1842 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001843 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001844 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001845 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1846 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1847 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
1848 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
1849 notifying haproxy again.
1850
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001851tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001852 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
1853 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
1854 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001855 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001856 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001857 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001858 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
1859 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
1860 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01001861 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
1862 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001863
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001864tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02001865 This option disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001866 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
1867 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
1868 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
1869 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
1870 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
1871
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001872tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
1873 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001874 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001875 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
1876 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
1877 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
1878 being used for too long.
1879
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001880tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
1881 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
1882 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
1883 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
1884 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
1885 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
1886 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
1887 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
1888 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
1889 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
1890 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001891 best value. HAProxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001892 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001893
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001894tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
1895 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
1896 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
1897 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
1898 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
1899 this maximum value. Default value if 1024. Only 1024 or higher values are
1900 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
1901 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001902 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
1903 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001904
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02001905tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
1906 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
1907 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
1908 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
1909 1000 entries.
1910
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01001911tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number>
1912 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client-hello cipher
1913 list. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled, otherwise
1914 a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
1915
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001916tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001917tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001918tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
1919tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
1920tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001921 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
1922 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
1923 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
1924 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
1925 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
1926 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
1927 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
1928 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001929
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01001930 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
1931 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
1932 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
1933 all available space is consumed.
1934 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
1935 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
1936 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001937
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001938tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
1939 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001940 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001941 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001942 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001943 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
1944
1945tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
1946 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
1947 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001948 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
1949 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001950
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019513.3. Debugging
1952--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001953
1954debug
1955 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
1956 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
1957 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
1958 system startup.
1959
1960quiet
1961 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
1962 line argument "-q".
1963
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001964
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010019653.4. Userlists
1966--------------
1967It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
1968http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
1969it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
1970
1971userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001972 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001973 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
1974
1975group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001976 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001977 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
1978 proceeded by "users" keyword.
1979
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001980user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
1981 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001982 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
1983 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01001984 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
1985 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
1986 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
1987 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001988
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01001989 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
1990 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
1991 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
1992 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
1993 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
1994 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
1995 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
1996 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in haproxy's
1997 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001998
1999 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002000 userlist L1
2001 group G1 users tiger,scott
2002 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002003
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002004 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
2005 user scott insecure-password elgato
2006 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002007
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002008 userlist L2
2009 group G1
2010 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002011
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002012 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
2013 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
2014 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002015
2016 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002017
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002018
20193.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002020----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02002021It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
2022several haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
2023instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
2024values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
2025automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
2026In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
2027using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
2028tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
2029reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
2030Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
2031that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
2032each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002033
2034peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002035 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002036 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
2037
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002038bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2039 Defines the binding parameters of the local peer of this "peers" section.
2040 Such lines are not supported with "peer" line in the same "peers" section.
2041
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002042disabled
2043 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
2044 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
2045 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
2046
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002047default-bind [param*]
2048 Defines the binding parameters for the local peer, excepted its address.
2049
2050default-server [param*]
2051 Change default options for a server in a "peers" section.
2052
2053 Arguments:
2054 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2055 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2056 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2057 details.
2058
2059
2060 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
2061
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002062enable
2063 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
2064
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002065peer <peername> <ip>:<port> [param*]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002066 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
2067 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
2068 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
2069 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
2070 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
2071 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
2072
2073 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
2074 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
2075
2076 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
2077 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
2078 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
2079 across all peers.
2080
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002081 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
2082 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002083
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002084 Note: "peer" keyword may transparently be replaced by "server" keyword (see
2085 "server" keyword explanation below).
2086
2087server <peername> [<ip>:<port>] [param*]
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02002088 As previously mentioned, "peer" keyword may be replaced by "server" keyword
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002089 with a support for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph.
2090 If the underlying peer is local, <ip>:<port> parameters must not be present.
2091 These parameters must be provided on a "bind" line (see "bind" keyword
2092 of this "peers" section).
2093 Some of these parameters are irrelevant for "peers" sections.
2094
2095
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002096 Example:
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002097 # The old way.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002098 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002099 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
2100 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
2101 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002102
2103 backend mybackend
2104 mode tcp
2105 balance roundrobin
2106 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
2107 stick on src
2108
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002109 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2110 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002111
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002112 Example:
2113 peers mypeers
2114 bind 127.0.0.11:10001 ssl crt mycerts/pem
2115 default-server ssl verify none
2116 server hostA 127.0.0.10:10000
2117 server hostB #local peer
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002118
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002119
2120table <tablename> type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
2121 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [store <data_type>]*
2122
2123 Configure a stickiness table for the current section. This line is parsed
2124 exactly the same way as the "stick-table" keyword in others section, except
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002125 for the "peers" argument which is not required here and with an additional
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002126 mandatory first parameter to designate the stick-table. Contrary to others
2127 sections, there may be several "table" lines in "peers" sections (see also
2128 "stick-table" keyword).
2129
2130 Also be aware of the fact that "peers" sections have their own stick-table
2131 namespaces to avoid collisions between stick-table names identical in
2132 different "peers" section. This is internally handled prepending the "peers"
2133 sections names to the name of the stick-tables followed by a '/' character.
2134 If somewhere else in the configuration file you have to refer to such
2135 stick-tables declared in "peers" sections you must use the prefixed version
2136 of the stick-table name as follows:
2137
2138 peers mypeers
2139 peer A ...
2140 peer B ...
2141 table t1 ...
2142
2143 frontend fe1
2144 tcp-request content track-sc0 src table mypeers/t1
2145
2146 This is also this prefixed version of the stick-table names which must be
2147 used to refer to stick-tables through the CLI.
2148
2149 About "peers" protocol, as only "peers" belonging to the same section may
2150 communicate with each others, there is no need to do such a distinction.
2151 Several "peers" sections may declare stick-tables with the same name.
2152 This is shorter version of the stick-table name which is sent over the network.
2153 There is only a '/' character as prefix to avoid stick-table name collisions between
2154 stick-tables declared as backends and stick-table declared in "peers" sections
2155 as follows in this weird but supported configuration:
2156
2157 peers mypeers
2158 peer A ...
2159 peer B ...
2160 table t1 type string size 10m store gpc0
2161
2162 backend t1
2163 stick-table type string size 10m store gpc0 peers mypeers
2164
2165 Here "t1" table declared in "mypeeers" section has "mypeers/t1" as global name.
2166 "t1" table declared as a backend as "t1" as global name. But at peer protocol
2167 level the former table is named "/t1", the latter is again named "t1".
2168
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090021693.6. Mailers
2170------------
2171It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
2172If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
2173in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
2174
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02002175mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002176 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
2177 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
2178
2179mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
2180 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
2181
2182 Example:
2183 mailers mymailers
2184 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
2185 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
2186
2187 backend mybackend
2188 mode tcp
2189 balance roundrobin
2190
2191 email-alert mailers mymailers
2192 email-alert from test1@horms.org
2193 email-alert to test2@horms.org
2194
2195 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2196 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
2197
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01002198timeout mail <time>
2199 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
2200 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
2201 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
2202 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
2203
2204 Example:
2205 mailers mymailers
2206 timeout mail 20s
2207 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002208
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +020022093.7. Programs
2210-------------
2211In master-worker mode, it is possible to launch external binaries with the
2212master, these processes are called programs. These programs are launched and
2213managed the same way as the workers.
2214
2215During a reload of HAProxy, those processes are dealing with the same
2216sequence as a worker:
2217
2218 - the master is re-executed
2219 - the master sends a SIGUSR1 signal to the program
2220 - if "option start-on-reload" is not disabled, the master launches a new
2221 instance of the program
2222
2223During a stop, or restart, a SIGTERM is sent to the programs.
2224
2225program <name>
2226 This is a new program section, this section will create an instance <name>
2227 which is visible in "show proc" on the master CLI. (See "9.4. Master CLI" in
2228 the management guide).
2229
2230command <command> [arguments*]
2231 Define the command to start with optional arguments. The command is looked
2232 up in the current PATH if it does not include an absolute path. This is a
2233 mandatory option of the program section. Arguments containing spaces must
2234 be enclosed in quotes or double quotes or be prefixed by a backslash.
2235
2236option start-on-reload
2237no option start-on-reload
2238 Start (or not) a new instance of the program upon a reload of the master.
2239 The default is to start a new instance. This option may only be used in a
2240 program section.
2241
2242
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020022434. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002244----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002245
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002246Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
William Lallemand6e62fb62015-04-28 16:55:23 +02002247 - defaults [<name>]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002248 - frontend <name>
2249 - backend <name>
2250 - listen <name>
2251
2252A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
2253its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
2254section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002255section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002256
2257A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
2258connections.
2259
2260A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
2261to forward incoming connections.
2262
2263A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
2264parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
2265
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002266All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
2267'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
2268case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
2269
2270Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
2271logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
2272proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
2273However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
2274name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
2275
2276Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
2277and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002278bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002279protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
2280modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
2281arbitrary criteria.
2282
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002283In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
2284a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002285the backend's. HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002286
2287 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
2288 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
2289 between responses and new requests.
2290
2291 - TUN: tunnel ("option http-tunnel") : this was the default mode for versions
2292 1.0 to 1.5-dev21 : only the first request and response are processed, and
2293 everything else is forwarded with no analysis at all. This mode should not
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +01002294 be used as it creates lots of trouble with logging and HTTP processing.
2295 And because it cannot work in HTTP/2, this option is deprecated and it is
2296 only supported on legacy HTTP frontends. In HTX, it is ignored and a
2297 warning is emitted during HAProxy startup.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002298
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002299 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
2300 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
2301 client-facing connection remains open.
2302
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002303 - CLO: close ("option httpclose"): the connection is closed after the end of
2304 the response and "Connection: close" appended in both directions.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002305
2306The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
2307frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
2308following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002309weakest option and close is the strongest.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002310
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002311 Backend mode
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002312
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002313 | KAL | SCL | CLO
2314 ----+-----+-----+----
2315 KAL | KAL | SCL | CLO
2316 ----+-----+-----+----
2317 TUN | TUN | SCL | CLO
2318 Frontend ----+-----+-----+----
2319 mode SCL | SCL | SCL | CLO
2320 ----+-----+-----+----
2321 CLO | CLO | CLO | CLO
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002322
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002323
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002324
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020023254.1. Proxy keywords matrix
2326--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002327
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002328The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
2329limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
2330they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
2331limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002332marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002333option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02002334and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
2335with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
2336specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002337
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002338
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002339 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
2340------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2341acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002342backlog X X X -
2343balance X - X X
2344bind - X X -
2345bind-process X X X X
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02002346block (deprecated) - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002347capture cookie - X X -
2348capture request header - X X -
2349capture response header - X X -
2350clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002351compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002352contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
2353cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02002354declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002355default-server X - X X
2356default_backend X X X -
2357description - X X X
2358disabled X X X X
2359dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002360email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09002361email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002362email-alert mailers X X X X
2363email-alert myhostname X X X X
2364email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002365enabled X X X X
2366errorfile X X X X
2367errorloc X X X X
2368errorloc302 X X X X
2369-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2370errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002371force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02002372filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002373fullconn X - X X
2374grace X X X X
2375hash-type X - X X
2376http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002377http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02002378http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002379http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02002380http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02002381http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02002382http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002383id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002384ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002385load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002386log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01002387log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02002388log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01002389log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02002390max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002391maxconn X X X -
2392mode X X X X
2393monitor fail - X X -
2394monitor-net X X X -
2395monitor-uri X X X -
2396option abortonclose (*) X - X X
2397option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
2398option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
2399option allbackups (*) X - X X
2400option checkcache (*) X - X X
2401option clitcpka (*) X X X -
2402option contstats (*) X X X -
2403option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
2404option dontlognull (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002405-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2406option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02002407option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02002408option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01002409option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02002410option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02002411option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002412option http-server-close (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +01002413option http-tunnel (deprecated) (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002414option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02002415option http-use-htx (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002416option httpchk X - X X
2417option httpclose (*) X X X X
Freddy Spierenburge88b7732019-03-25 14:35:17 +01002418option httplog X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002419option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002420option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02002421option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002422option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002423option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
2424option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
2425option logasap (*) X X X -
2426option mysql-check X - X X
2427option nolinger (*) X X X X
2428option originalto X X X X
2429option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02002430option pgsql-check X - X X
2431option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002432option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02002433option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002434option smtpchk X - X X
2435option socket-stats (*) X X X -
2436option splice-auto (*) X X X X
2437option splice-request (*) X X X X
2438option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01002439option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002440option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
2441option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
2442-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01002443option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002444option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
2445option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
2446option tcpka X X X X
2447option tcplog X X X X
2448option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002449external-check command X - X X
2450external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002451persist rdp-cookie X - X X
2452rate-limit sessions X X X -
2453redirect - X X X
2454redisp (deprecated) X - X X
2455redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02002456reqadd (deprecated) - X X X
2457reqallow (deprecated) - X X X
2458reqdel (deprecated) - X X X
2459reqdeny (deprecated) - X X X
2460reqiallow (deprecated) - X X X
2461reqidel (deprecated) - X X X
2462reqideny (deprecated) - X X X
2463reqipass (deprecated) - X X X
2464reqirep (deprecated) - X X X
2465reqitarpit (deprecated) - X X X
2466reqpass (deprecated) - X X X
2467reqrep (deprecated) - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002468-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02002469reqtarpit (deprecated) - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002470retries X - X X
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02002471retry-on X - X X
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02002472rspadd (deprecated) - X X X
2473rspdel (deprecated) - X X X
2474rspdeny (deprecated) - X X X
2475rspidel (deprecated) - X X X
2476rspideny (deprecated) - X X X
2477rspirep (deprecated) - X X X
2478rsprep (deprecated) - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002479server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002480server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02002481server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002482source X - X X
2483srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02002484stats admin - X X X
2485stats auth X X X X
2486stats enable X X X X
2487stats hide-version X X X X
2488stats http-request - X X X
2489stats realm X X X X
2490stats refresh X X X X
2491stats scope X X X X
2492stats show-desc X X X X
2493stats show-legends X X X X
2494stats show-node X X X X
2495stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002496-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2497stick match - - X X
2498stick on - - X X
2499stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02002500stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01002501stick-table - X X X
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02002502tcp-check connect - - X X
2503tcp-check expect - - X X
2504tcp-check send - - X X
2505tcp-check send-binary - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02002506tcp-request connection - X X -
2507tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02002508tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02002509tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02002510tcp-response content - - X X
2511tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002512timeout check X - X X
2513timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002514timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002515timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
2516timeout connect X - X X
2517timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
2518timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
2519timeout http-request X X X X
2520timeout queue X - X X
2521timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002522timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002523timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
2524timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02002525timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002526transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01002527unique-id-format X X X -
2528unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002529use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02002530use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002531------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2532 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002533
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002534
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020025354.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
2536---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002537
2538This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
2539
2540
2541acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
2542 Declare or complete an access list.
2543 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2544 no | yes | yes | yes
2545 Example:
2546 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2547 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2548 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
2549
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002550 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002551
2552
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002553backlog <conns>
2554 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
2555 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2556 yes | yes | yes | no
2557 Arguments :
2558 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
2559 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002560 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002561
2562 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
2563 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
2564 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
2565 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
2566 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
2567 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
2568 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
2569 backlog parameter.
2570
2571 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
2572 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
2573 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
2574
2575 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
2576
2577
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002578balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002579balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002580 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
2581 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2582 yes | no | yes | yes
2583 Arguments :
2584 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
2585 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
2586 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
2587 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
2588
2589 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2590 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
2591 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
2592 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002593 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08002594 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002595 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
2596 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
2597 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
2598 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
2599 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
2600 it, so that you don't worry.
2601
2602 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2603 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
2604 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
2605 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
2606 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
2607 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
2608 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
2609 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002610
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01002611 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
2612 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
2613 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
2614 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
2615 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
2616 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
2617 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
2618 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
2619
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002620 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002621 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002622 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
2623 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002624 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002625 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
2626 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
2627 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
2628 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
2629 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002630 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
2631 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
2632 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
2633 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
2634 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
2635 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002636
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002637 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
2638 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
2639 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
2640 address will always reach the same server as long as no
2641 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
2642 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
2643 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
2644 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002645 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002646 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002647 static by default, which means that changing a server's
2648 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
2649 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002650
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002651 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
2652 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
2653 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
2654 the running servers. The result designates which server will
2655 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
2656 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
2657 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
2658 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
2659 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
2660 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2661 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2662 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002663
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002664 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002665 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
2666 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
2667 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
2668 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
2669 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
2670 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
2671 URIs start with a leading "/".
2672
2673 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
2674 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
2675 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
2676 evaluation stops when either is reached.
2677
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002678 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002679 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
2680
2681 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002682 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
2683 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002684 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
2685 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
2686 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
2687 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002688 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002689 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
2690 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002691
2692 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
2693 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
2694 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
2695 server will receive the request.
2696
2697 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
2698 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
2699 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
2700 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
2701 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002702 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
2703 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
2704 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002705
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002706 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
2707 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
2708 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
2709 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
2710 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002711
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002712 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002713 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
2714 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
2715 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
2716
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002717 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2718 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2719 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2720
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01002721 random
2722 random(<draws>)
2723 A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02002724 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
2725 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
2726 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
2727 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01002728 or removed as it may avoid the hammering effect that could
2729 result from roundrobin or leastconn in this situation. The
2730 hash-balance-factor directive can be used to further improve
2731 fairness of the load balancing, especially in situations
2732 where servers show highly variable response times. When an
2733 argument <draws> is present, it must be an integer value one
2734 or greater, indicating the number of draws before selecting
2735 the least loaded of these servers. It was indeed demonstrated
2736 that picking the least loaded of two servers is enough to
2737 significantly improve the fairness of the algorithm, by
2738 always avoiding to pick the most loaded server within a farm
2739 and getting rid of any bias that could be induced by the
2740 unfair distribution of the consistent list. Higher values N
2741 will take away N-1 of the highest loaded servers at the
2742 expense of performance. With very high values, the algorithm
2743 will converge towards the leastconn's result but much slower.
2744 The default value is 2, which generally shows very good
2745 distribution and performance. This algorithm is also known as
2746 the Power of Two Random Choices and is described here :
2747 http://www.eecs.harvard.edu/~michaelm/postscripts/handbook2001.pdf
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02002748
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002749 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02002750 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002751 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
2752 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
2753 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
2754 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
2755 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
2756 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002757 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002758 used instead.
2759
2760 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
2761 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
2762 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
2763 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
2764
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002765 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2766 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2767 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2768
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002769 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09002770
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002771 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002772 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
2773 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002774
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01002775 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
2776 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
2777 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002778
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02002779 With authentication schemes that require the same connection like NTLM, URI
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002780 based algorithms must not be used, as they would cause subsequent requests
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02002781 to be routed to different backend servers, breaking the invalid assumptions
2782 NTLM relies on.
2783
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002784 Examples :
2785 balance roundrobin
2786 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002787 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002788 balance hdr(User-Agent)
2789 balance hdr(host)
2790 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002791
2792 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
2793 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
2794
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002795 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002796 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
2797 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
2798 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
2799 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
2800
2801 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
2802 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
2803 defaults to 16 kB.
2804
2805 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
2806 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
2807
2808 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
2809 Round Robin.
2810
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00002811 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002812 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
2813 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
2814 actually appeared in the first chunk).
2815
2816 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
2817
2818 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002819 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002820 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
2821 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
2822 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002823
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002824 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002825
2826
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002827bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2828bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002829 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
2830 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2831 no | yes | yes | no
2832 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002833 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
2834 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
2835 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
2836 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01002837 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002838 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
2839 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
2840 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
2841 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
2842 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
2843 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
2844 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02002845 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
2846 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
2847 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
2848 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
2849 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
2850 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
2851 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01002852 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
2853 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
2854 be listening.
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02002855 - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
2856 connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
2857 to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
2858 was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002859 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
2860 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
2861 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002862
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002863 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
2864 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002865 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
2866 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
2867 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002868 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
2869 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
2870 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
2871 the range.
2872
2873 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
2874 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
2875 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
2876 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
2877 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
2878 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
2879 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002880 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002881 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002882
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002883 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002884 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002885 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
2886 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
2887 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
2888 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
2889 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
2890 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
2891
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002892 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
2893 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
2894 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
2895 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002896
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002897 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
2898 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
2899 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
2900 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
2901 in a frontend.
2902
2903 Example :
2904 listen http_proxy
2905 bind :80,:443
2906 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002907 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002908
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002909 listen http_https_proxy
2910 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02002911 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002912
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002913 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
2914 bind ipv6@:80
2915 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
2916 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
2917
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002918 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002919 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002920
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02002921 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
2922 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
2923 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
2924 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
2925 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
2926
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002927 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002928 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002929
2930
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01002931bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[<process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002932 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
2933 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2934 yes | yes | yes | yes
2935 Arguments :
2936 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
2937 may be used to override a default value.
2938
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002939 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002940 option may be combined with other numbers.
2941
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002942 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002943 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
2944 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
2945 missing from all processes.
2946
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01002947 process_num The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002948 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01002949 the machine's word size. Ranges can be partially defined. The
2950 higher bound can be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by
2951 the corresponding maximum value. If a proxy is bound to
2952 process numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it
2953 will either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02002954 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002955
2956 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
2957 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
2958 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
2959 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
2960 and 'even' instances.
2961
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002962 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
2963 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
2964 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
2965 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002966
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002967 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
2968 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
2969
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02002970 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
2971 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
2972 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
2973
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002974 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
2975 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
2976
2977 Example :
2978 listen app_ip1
2979 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002980 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002981
2982 listen app_ip2
2983 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002984 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002985
2986 listen management
2987 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002988 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002989
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01002990 listen management
2991 bind 10.0.0.4:80
2992 bind-process 1-4
2993
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002994 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002995
2996
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02002997block { if | unless } <condition> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002998 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
2999 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3000 no | yes | yes | yes
3001
3002 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
3003 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003004 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02003005 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003006 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +03003007 "block" statements per instance. To block connections at layer 4 (without
3008 sending a 403 error) see "tcp-request connection reject" and
3009 "tcp-request content reject" rules.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003010
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02003011 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
3012 "http-request deny" instead.
3013
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003014 Example:
3015 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
3016 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
3017 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +03003018 # block is deprecated. Use http-request deny instead:
3019 #block if invalid_src || local_dst
3020 http-request deny if invalid_src || local_dst
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003021
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +03003022 See also : section 7 about ACL usage, "http-request deny",
3023 "http-response deny", "tcp-request connection reject" and
3024 "tcp-request content reject".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003025
3026capture cookie <name> len <length>
3027 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
3028 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3029 no | yes | yes | no
3030 Arguments :
3031 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
3032 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
3033 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
3034 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003035 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003036
3037 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
3038 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
3039 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
3040 right if it exceeds <length>.
3041
3042 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
3043 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
3044 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
3045 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
3046
3047 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
3048 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
3049 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
3050
3051 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
3052 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
3053 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01003054 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
3055 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
3056 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003057
3058 Example:
3059 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
3060
3061 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003062 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003063
3064
3065capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003066 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003067 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3068 no | yes | yes | no
3069 Arguments :
3070 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003071 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003072 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
3073 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3074 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3075
3076 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3077 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3078 it exceeds <length>.
3079
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003080 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003081 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
3082 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003083 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
3084 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
3085 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
3086 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003087 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003088 environments to find where the request came from.
3089
3090 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
3091 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
3092 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
3093 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003094
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003095 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
3096 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3097 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3098 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3099 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003100
3101 Example:
3102 capture request header Host len 15
3103 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01003104 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003105
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003106 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003107 about logging.
3108
3109
3110capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003111 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003112 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3113 no | yes | yes | no
3114 Arguments :
3115 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003116 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003117 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
3118 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3119 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3120
3121 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3122 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3123 it exceeds <length>.
3124
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003125 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003126 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
3127 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
3128 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003129 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
3130 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
3131 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
3132 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003133
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003134 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
3135 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3136 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3137 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3138 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003139
3140 Example:
3141 capture response header Content-length len 9
3142 capture response header Location len 15
3143
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003144 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003145 about logging.
3146
3147
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003148clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003149 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
3150 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3151 yes | yes | yes | no
3152 Arguments :
3153 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
3154 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3155 as explained at the top of this document.
3156
3157 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
3158 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
3159 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
3160 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
3161 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
3162 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
3163 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
3164 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003165 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003166 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003167 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003168
3169 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
3170 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
3171 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
3172 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
3173 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
3174 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
3175
3176 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
3177 Please use "timeout client" instead.
3178
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01003179 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
3180 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003181
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003182compression algo <algorithm> ...
3183compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003184compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003185 Enable HTTP compression.
3186 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3187 yes | yes | yes | yes
3188 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003189 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
3190 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
3191 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
3192
3193 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003194 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
3195 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
3196 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003197
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003198 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003199 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003200
3201 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
3202 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
3203 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
3204 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
3205 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003206 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003207
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003208 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
3209 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
3210 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
3211 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
3212 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
3213 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
3214 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003215 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003216
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04003217 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003218 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003219 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
3220 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
3221 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
3222 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
3223 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003224
3225 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
3226 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
3227 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
3228 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
3229 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003230 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
3231 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
3232 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
3233 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
3234 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02003235 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
3236 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003237
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003238 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003239 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
3240 "Accept-Encoding" header
3241 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003242 * HTTP status code is not one of 200, 201, 202, or 203
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003243 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
3244 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
3245 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
3246 "multipart"
3247 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
3248 header
3249 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
3250 and later
3251 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
3252 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003253 * The response contains an invalid "ETag" header or multiple ETag headers
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003254
Tim Duesterhusb229f012019-01-29 16:38:56 +01003255 Note: The compression does not emit the Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003256
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003257 Examples :
3258 compression algo gzip
3259 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003260
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003261
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003262contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003263 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
3264 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3265 yes | no | yes | yes
3266 Arguments :
3267 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
3268 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3269 as explained at the top of this document.
3270
3271 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003272 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003273 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003274 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003275 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
3276 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
3277 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
3278
3279 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
3280 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
3281 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
3282 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
3283 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
3284 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
3285
3286 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
3287 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
3288 instead.
3289
3290 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
3291 "timeout server", "contimeout".
3292
3293
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003294cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003295 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
3296 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003297 [ dynamic ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003298 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
3299 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3300 yes | no | yes | yes
3301 Arguments :
3302 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
3303 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
3304 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
3305 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
3306 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
3307 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003308 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003309 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
3310 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
3311
3312 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
3313 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
3314 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
3315 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
3316 headers is left to the application. The application can then
3317 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003318 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
3319 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003320 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003321 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
3322 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003323
3324 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003325 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003326
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003327 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003328 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02003329 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be removed before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003330 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003331 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
3332 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
3333 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
3334 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
3335 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
3336 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
3337 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003338
3339 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
3340 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
3341 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
3342 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
3343 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
3344 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
3345 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
3346 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
3347 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003348 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003349 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
3350 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
3351 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003352
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003353 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
3354 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
3355 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003356 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
3357 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
3358 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
3359 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003360 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
3361 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
3362 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003363
3364 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
3365 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
3366 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
3367 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
3368 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
3369 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
3370 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
3371 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
3372 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
3373
3374 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
3375 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
3376 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
3377 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
3378 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
3379 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
3380 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
3381 persistence cookie in the cache.
3382 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
3383
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003384 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
3385 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
3386 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
3387 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
3388 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003389 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003390 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
3391 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
3392 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
3393 they logout.
3394
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003395 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
3396 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
3397 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
3398 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
3399
3400 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
3401 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
3402 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
3403 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
3404 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
3405 this attribute.
3406
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003407 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003408 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01003409 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
3410 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
3411 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
3412 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
3413 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
3414 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003415
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003416 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
3417 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
3418 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
3419 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
3420 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
3421 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
3422 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
3423 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003424 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003425 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
3426 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
3427 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
3428 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
3429 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
3430 the site.
3431
3432 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
3433 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
3434 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
3435 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
3436 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
3437 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
3438 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
3439 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
3440 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
3441 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
3442 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
3443 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
3444 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003445 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003446 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
3447 redispatch after some absolute delay.
3448
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003449 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
3450 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
3451 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
3452 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
3453 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
3454 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
3455
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003456 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
3457 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
3458 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
3459 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003460
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003461 Examples :
3462 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
3463 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
3464 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003465 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003466
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02003467 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003468
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003469
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003470declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
3471 Declares a capture slot.
3472 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3473 no | yes | yes | no
3474 Arguments:
3475 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
3476
3477 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
3478 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
3479 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
3480 for use in the response.
3481
3482 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02003483 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003484 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
3485
3486
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003487default-server [param*]
3488 Change default options for a server in a backend
3489 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3490 yes | no | yes | yes
3491 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003492 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
3493 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
3494 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
3495 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003496
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003497 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003498 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
3499
3500 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003501
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003502
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003503default_backend <backend>
3504 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
3505 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3506 yes | yes | yes | no
3507 Arguments :
3508 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
3509
3510 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
3511 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
3512 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
3513 will catch all undetermined requests.
3514
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003515 Example :
3516
3517 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
3518 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
3519 default_backend dynamic
3520
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02003521 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003522
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003523
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02003524description <string>
3525 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
3526 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3527 no | yes | yes | yes
3528 Arguments : string
3529
3530 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
3531 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
3532 it describes.
3533 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
3534
3535
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003536disabled
3537 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3538 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3539 yes | yes | yes | yes
3540 Arguments : none
3541
3542 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
3543 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
3544 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
3545 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
3546 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
3547 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
3548 keyword in a "defaults" section.
3549
3550 See also : "enabled"
3551
3552
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003553dispatch <address>:<port>
3554 Set a default server address
3555 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3556 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003557 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003558
3559 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
3560 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
3561 during start-up.
3562
3563 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
3564 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
3565 possible with normal servers.
3566
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02003567 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003568 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
3569 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
3570 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
3571 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
3572
3573 See also : "server"
3574
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003575
3576dynamic-cookie-key <string>
3577 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
3578 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3579 yes | no | yes | yes
3580 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
3581
3582 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003583 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003584 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
3585 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003586 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003587 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003588
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003589enabled
3590 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3591 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3592 yes | yes | yes | yes
3593 Arguments : none
3594
3595 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
3596 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
3597
3598 See also : "disabled"
3599
3600
3601errorfile <code> <file>
3602 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3603 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3604 yes | yes | yes | yes
3605 Arguments :
3606 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003607 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3608 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003609
3610 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003611 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003612 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003613 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
3614 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003615
3616 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3617 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3618 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3619
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003620 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3621
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003622 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
3623 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
3624 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
3625 files returning the same contents as default errors.
3626
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003627 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
3628 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003629 not to put any reference to local contents (e.g. images) in order to avoid
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003630 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
3631 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
3632 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
3633
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003634 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
3635 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
3636 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003637 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003638 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
3639
3640 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
3641
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003642 Example :
3643 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003644 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003645 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
3646 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
3647
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003648
3649errorloc <code> <url>
3650errorloc302 <code> <url>
3651 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3652 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3653 yes | yes | yes | yes
3654 Arguments :
3655 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003656 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3657 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003658
3659 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3660 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3661 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3662 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003663 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003664
3665 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3666 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3667 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3668
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003669 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3670
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003671 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
3672 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
3673 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
3674 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003675 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003676 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
3677 request.
3678
3679 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
3680
3681
3682errorloc303 <code> <url>
3683 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3684 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3685 yes | yes | yes | yes
3686 Arguments :
3687 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003688 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3689 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003690
3691 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3692 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3693 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3694 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003695 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003696
3697 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3698 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3699 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3700
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003701 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3702
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003703 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
3704 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
3705 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
3706 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003707 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003708
3709 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
3710
3711
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003712email-alert from <emailaddr>
3713 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003714 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003715 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3716 yes | yes | yes | yes
3717
3718 Arguments :
3719
3720 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
3721
3722 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3723 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3724
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003725 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02003726 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
3727 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003728
3729
3730email-alert level <level>
3731 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
3732 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
3733 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3734 yes | yes | yes | yes
3735
3736 Arguments :
3737
3738 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
3739 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
3740 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
3741
3742 By default level is alert
3743
3744 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3745 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3746 for the proxy.
3747
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09003748 Alerts are sent when :
3749
3750 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
3751 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
3752 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
3753 is notice or lower
3754 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
3755 and a health check status update occurs
3756
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003757 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
3758 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003759 section 3.6 about mailers.
3760
3761
3762email-alert mailers <mailersect>
3763 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
3764 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3765 yes | yes | yes | yes
3766
3767 Arguments :
3768
3769 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
3770
3771 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
3772 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3773
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003774 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
3775 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003776
3777
3778email-alert myhostname <hostname>
3779 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
3780 mailers.
3781 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3782 yes | yes | yes | yes
3783
3784 Arguments :
3785
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01003786 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003787
3788 By default the systems hostname is used.
3789
3790 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3791 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3792 for the proxy.
3793
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003794 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
3795 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003796
3797
3798email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003799 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003800 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
3801 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3802 yes | yes | yes | yes
3803
3804 Arguments :
3805
3806 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
3807
3808 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3809 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3810
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003811 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003812 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
3813
3814
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003815force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3816 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
3817 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003818 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003819
3820 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
3821 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
3822 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
3823 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
3824 marked down for maintenance operations.
3825
3826 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
3827 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
3828 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
3829 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
3830 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
3831 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
3832 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
3833 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
3834 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
3835
3836 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
3837 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
3838 is used.
3839
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003840 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02003841 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003842
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003843
3844filter <name> [param*]
3845 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
3846 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3847 no | yes | yes | yes
3848 Arguments :
3849 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
3850 referenced in section 9.
3851
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003852 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003853 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003854 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
3855 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003856
3857 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
3858 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
3859
3860 Example:
3861 listen
3862 bind *:80
3863
3864 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
3865 filter compression
3866 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
3867
3868 compression algo gzip
3869 compression offload
3870
3871 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
3872
3873 See also : section 9.
3874
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003875
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003876fullconn <conns>
3877 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
3878 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3879 yes | no | yes | yes
3880 Arguments :
3881 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
3882 servers use the maximal number of connections.
3883
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003884 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003885 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003886 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003887 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
3888 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
3889 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
3890 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
3891 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003892 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003893
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003894 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
3895 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01003896 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
3897 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
3898 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003899
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003900 Example :
3901 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
3902 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
3903 # connections.
3904 backend dynamic
3905 fullconn 10000
3906 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3907 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3908
3909 See also : "maxconn", "server"
3910
3911
3912grace <time>
3913 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
3914 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01003915 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003916 Arguments :
3917 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
3918 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
3919 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
3920
3921 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
3922 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003923 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003924 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
3925
3926 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
3927 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
3928 simplify it.
3929
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003930
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003931hash-balance-factor <factor>
3932 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
3933 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3934 yes | no | no | yes
3935 Arguments :
3936 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
3937 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01003938 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003939
3940 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
3941 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
3942 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
3943 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
3944 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
3945 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
3946 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
3947
3948 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
3949 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
3950 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
3951 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
3952 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
3953
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003954 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
3955 consistent hashing mechanism.
3956
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003957 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
3958
3959
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003960hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003961 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
3962 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3963 yes | no | yes | yes
3964 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003965 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
3966 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003967
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003968 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
3969 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
3970 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
3971 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
3972 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
3973 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
3974 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
3975 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
3976 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
3977 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01003978
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003979 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
3980 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
3981 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
3982 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
3983 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
3984 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
3985 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
3986 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
3987 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
3988 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
3989 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
3990 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
3991 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003992 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
3993 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003994
3995 <function> is the hash function to be used :
3996
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003997 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003998 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
3999 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
4000 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004001 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
4002 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
4003 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004004
4005 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
4006 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004007 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
4008 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
4009 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
4010 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
4011
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01004012 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
4013 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
4014 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
4015 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
4016 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
4017 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
4018 parameter.
4019
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01004020 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
4021 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
4022 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
4023 used on strings.
4024
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004025 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
4026
4027 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
4028 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
4029 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
4030 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
4031 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
4032 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
4033 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
4034 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
4035 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
4036 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
4037 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
4038 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004039
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004040 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
4041 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
4042 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004043
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004044 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004045
4046
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004047http-check disable-on-404
4048 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
4049 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004050 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004051 Arguments : none
4052
4053 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
4054 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
4055 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
4056 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
4057 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
4058 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
4059 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
4060 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004061 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
4062 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
4063 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
4064
4065 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
4066
4067
4068http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004069 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004070 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02004071 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004072 Arguments :
4073 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
4074 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004075 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004076 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
4077 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
4078 details on the supported keywords.
4079
4080 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
4081 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
4082 with the usual backslash ('\').
4083
4084 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
4085 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
4086 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
4087 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
4088 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
4089
4090 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004091 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004092 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
4093 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4094 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
4095
4096 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004097 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004098 response's status code matches the expression. If the
4099 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4100 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
4101 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
4102
4103 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004104 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004105 response's body contains this exact string. If the
4106 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4107 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
4108 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
4109 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004110 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004111 trace).
4112
4113 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004114 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004115 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
4116 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
4117 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
4118 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
4119 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004120 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004121
4122 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
4123 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
4124 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
4125 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
4126 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
4127 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
4128 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
4129 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
4130
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01004131 Also "http-check expect" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
4132 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, meaning that this
4133 header should not be present in the request provided by "option httpchk".
4134
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004135 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
4136 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
4137
4138 Examples :
4139 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004140 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004141
4142 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004143 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004144
4145 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004146 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004147
4148 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03004149 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004150
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004151 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004152
4153
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004154http-check send-state
4155 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
4156 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4157 yes | no | yes | yes
4158 Arguments : none
4159
4160 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
4161 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
4162 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
4163 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
4164 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
4165
4166 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
4167 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
4168 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
4169 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
4170 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08004171 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
4172 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
4173 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
4174
4175 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
4176 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
4177 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
4178
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004179 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
4180 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
4181 checked in multiple backends.
4182
4183 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
4184 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
4185
4186 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
4187 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
4188 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
4189 one fails.
4190
4191 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
4192 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
4193 connections on all servers of the same backend.
4194
4195 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
4196 server's queue.
4197
4198 Example of a header received by the application server :
4199 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
4200 scur=13/22; qcur=0
4201
4202 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
4203
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004204
4205http-request <action> [options...] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004206 Access control for Layer 7 requests
4207
4208 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4209 no | yes | yes | yes
4210
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004211 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
4212 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
4213 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4214 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4215 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004216
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004217 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
4218 below.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004219
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004220 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004221
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004222 It is important to know that http-request rules are processed very early in
4223 the HTTP processing, just after "block" rules and before "reqdel" or "reqrep"
4224 or "reqadd" rules. That way, headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are
4225 visible by almost all further ACL rules.
Willy Tarreau53275e82017-11-24 07:52:01 +01004226
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004227 Using "reqadd"/"reqdel"/"reqrep" to manipulate request headers is discouraged
4228 in newer versions (>= 1.5). But if you need to use regular expression to
4229 delete headers, you can still use "reqdel". Also please use
4230 "http-request deny/allow/tarpit" instead of "reqdeny"/"reqpass"/"reqtarpit".
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01004231
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004232 Example:
4233 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
4234 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
4235 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004236
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004237 http-request allow if nagios
4238 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
4239 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
4240 http-request deny
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01004241
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004242 Example:
4243 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
4244 acl add path /addacl
4245 acl del path /delacl
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004246
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004247 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004248
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004249 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
4250 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004251
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004252 Example:
4253 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
4254 acl setmap path /setmap
4255 acl delmap path /delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004256
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004257 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004258
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004259 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
4260 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004261
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004262 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
4263 about ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004264
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004265http-request add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004266
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004267 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4268 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4269 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4270 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
4271 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values. This
4272 lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
4273 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4274 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004275
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004276http-request add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004277
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004278 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and
4279 whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see
4280 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
4281 connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the client's SSL
4282 certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This rule is not
4283 final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note that header
4284 addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse the resulting
4285 header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004286
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004287http-request allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004288
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004289 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request pass the check.
4290 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004291
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004292
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004293http-request auth [realm <realm>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004294
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004295 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds with an
4296 HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid user name
4297 and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An optional
4298 "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm that is
4299 returned with the response (typically the application's name).
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004300
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004301 Example:
4302 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
4303 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004304
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02004305http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004306
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004307 See section 10.2 about cache setup.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004308
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004309http-request capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
4310 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004311
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004312 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
4313 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
4314 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
4315 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
4316 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
4317 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
4318 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life.
4319 Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for
4320 more information.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004321
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004322 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store the
4323 captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful to run
4324 captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous directive
4325 "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword. If the slot
4326 <id> doesn't exist, then HAProxy fails parsing the configuration to prevent
4327 unexpected behavior at run time.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004328
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004329http-request del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004330
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004331 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4332 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4333 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4334 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4335 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4336 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004337
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004338http-request del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004339
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004340 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02004341
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004342http-request del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02004343
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004344 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4345 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4346 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4347 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4348 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
4349 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02004350
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004351http-request deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04004352
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004353 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the request
4354 and emits an HTTP 403 error, or optionally the status code specified as an
4355 argument to "deny_status". The list of permitted status codes is limited to
4356 those that can be overridden by the "errorfile" directive.
4357 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04004358
Olivier Houchard602bf7d2019-05-10 13:59:15 +02004359http-request disable-l7-retry [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4360 This disables any attempt to retry the request if it fails for any other
4361 reason than a connection failure. This can be useful for example to make
4362 sure POST requests aren't retried on failure.
4363
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01004364http-request do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr> :
4365
4366 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores
4367 the result in the variable <var>. It uses the DNS resolvers section
4368 pointed by <resolvers>.
4369 It is possible to choose a resolution preference using the optional
4370 arguments 'ipv4' or 'ipv6'.
4371 When performing the DNS resolution, the client side connection is on
4372 pause waiting till the end of the resolution.
4373 If an IP address can be found, it is stored into <var>. If any kind of
4374 error occurs, then <var> is not set.
4375 One can use this action to discover a server IP address at run time and
4376 based on information found in the request (IE a Host header).
4377 If this action is used to find the server's IP address (using the
4378 "set-dst" action), then the server IP address in the backend must be set
4379 to 0.0.0.0.
4380
4381 Example:
4382 resolvers mydns
4383 nameserver local 127.0.0.53:53
4384 nameserver google 8.8.8.8:53
4385 timeout retry 1s
4386 hold valid 10s
4387 hold nx 3s
4388 hold other 3s
4389 hold obsolete 0s
4390 accepted_payload_size 8192
4391
4392 frontend fe
4393 bind 10.42.0.1:80
4394 http-request do-resolve(txn.myip,mydns,ipv4) hdr(Host),lower
4395 http-request capture var(txn.myip) len 40
4396
4397 # return 503 when the variable is not set,
4398 # which mean DNS resolution error
4399 use_backend b_503 unless { var(txn.myip) -m found }
4400
4401 default_backend be
4402
4403 backend b_503
4404 # dummy backend used to return 503.
4405 # one can use the errorfile directive to send a nice
4406 # 503 error page to end users
4407
4408 backend be
4409 # rule to prevent HAProxy from reconnecting to services
4410 # on the local network (forged DNS name used to scan the network)
4411 http-request deny if { var(txn.myip) -m ip 127.0.0.0/8 10.0.0.0/8 }
4412 http-request set-dst var(txn.myip)
4413 server clear 0.0.0.0:0
4414
4415 NOTE: Don't forget to set the "protection" rules to ensure HAProxy won't
4416 be used to scan the network or worst won't loop over itself...
4417
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01004418http-request early-hint <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4419
4420 This is used to build an HTTP 103 Early Hints response prior to any other one.
4421 This appends an HTTP header field to this response whose name is specified in
4422 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules
4423 (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
Frédéric Lécaille3aac1062018-11-13 09:42:13 +01004424 to the client some Link headers to preload resources required to render the
4425 HTML documents.
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01004426
4427 See RFC 8297 for more information.
4428
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004429http-request redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004430
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004431 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule. This is exactly
4432 the same as the "redirect" statement except that it inserts a redirect rule
4433 which can be processed in the middle of other "http-request" rules and that
4434 these rules use the "log-format" strings. See the "redirect" keyword for the
4435 rule's syntax.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004436
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004437http-request reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004438
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004439 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes the connection
4440 without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
4441 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an immediate
4442 connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004443
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004444http-request replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4445 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02004446
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004447 This matches the regular expression in all occurrences of header field
4448 <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with the
4449 <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt and
4450 work like in <fmt> arguments in "http-request add-header". The match is
4451 only case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
4452 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they may
4453 contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas in
4454 their value, such as If-Modified-Since and so on.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02004455
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004456 Example:
4457 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01004458
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004459 # applied to:
4460 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004461
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004462 # outputs:
4463 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004464
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004465 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004466
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004467http-request replace-uri <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4468 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4469
4470 This matches the regular expression in the URI part of the request
4471 according to <match-regex>, and replaces it with the <replace-fmt>
4472 argument. Standard back-references using the backslash ('\') followed by a
4473 number are supported. The <fmt> field is interpreted as a log-format string
4474 so it may contain special expressions just like the <fmt> argument passed
4475 to "http-request set-uri". The match is exclusively case-sensitive. Any
4476 optional scheme, authority or query string are considered in the matching
4477 part of the URI. It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more
4478 expensive to evaluate than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit
4479 from a condition to avoid performing the evaluation at all if it does not
4480 match.
4481
4482 Example:
4483 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
4484 http-request replace-uri (.*) /foo\1
4485
4486 # suffix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /bar/foo?q=1 :
4487 http-request replace-uri ([^?]*)(\?(.*))? \1/foo\2
4488
4489 # strip /foo : turn /foo/bar?q=1 into /bar?q=1
4490 http-request replace-uri /foo/(.*) /\1
4491 # or more efficient if only some requests match :
4492 http-request replace-uri /foo/(.*) /\1 if { url_beg /foo/ }
4493
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004494http-request replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4495 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004496
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004497 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
4498 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the
4499 entire header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry
4500 more than one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004501
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004502 Example:
4503 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004504
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004505 # applied to:
4506 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004507
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004508 # outputs:
4509 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01004510
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004511http-request sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4512http-request sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004513
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004514 This actions increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
4515 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
4516 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004517
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004518http-request sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004519
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004520 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated by
4521 <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If an error
4522 occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004523
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004524http-request set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004525
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004526 This is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
4527 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination IP,
4528 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask the IP for
4529 privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0' as a
4530 server address in the backend.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004531
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004532 Arguments:
4533 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4534 by some converters.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004535
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004536 Example:
4537 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
4538 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004539
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004540 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as the
4541 address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004542
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004543http-request set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004544
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004545 This is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
4546 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0'
4547 as a server address in the backend.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004548
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004549 Arguments:
4550 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4551 followed by some converters.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004552
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004553 Example:
4554 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
4555 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004556
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004557 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
4558 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
4559 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004560
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004561http-request set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004562
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004563 This does the same as "http-request add-header" except that the header name
4564 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
4565 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
4566 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so it
4567 is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004568
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004569 Example:
4570 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
4571 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
4572 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
4573 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
4574 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
4575 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
4576 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
4577 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
4578 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004579
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004580http-request set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004581
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004582 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
4583 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
4584 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
4585 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule
4586 can be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004587
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004588http-request set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
4589 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004590
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004591 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4592 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4593 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
4594 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
4595 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
4596 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
4597 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
4598 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
4599 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004600
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004601http-request set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004602
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004603 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
4604 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
4605 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
4606 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by
4607 "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route
4608 (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
4609 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004610
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004611http-request set-method <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004612
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004613 This rewrites the request method with the result of the evaluation of format
4614 string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons for having to do so as
4615 this is more likely to break something than to fix it.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004616
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004617http-request set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004618
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004619 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. It only
4620 has effect against the other requests being processed at the same time.
4621 The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the "bind"
4622 line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the nicest
4623 the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important than
4624 other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
4625 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
4626 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004627
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004628http-request set-path <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004629
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004630 This rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of format
4631 string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a scheme and
4632 authority is found before the path, they are left intact as well. If the
4633 request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with the format.
4634 This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of a path for
4635 example. See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004636
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004637 Example :
4638 # prepend the host name before the path
4639 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004640
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004641http-request set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02004642
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004643 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request.
4644 The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer in the
4645 range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be truncated.
4646 The priority class determines the order in which queued requests are
4647 processed. Lower values have higher priority.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004648
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004649http-request set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004650
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004651 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
4652 request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer
4653 in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be truncated.
4654 When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority class, then by
4655 the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in milliseconds. Lower
4656 values have higher priority.
4657 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
4658 for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
4659 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
4660 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
4661 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004662
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004663http-request set-query <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004664
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004665 This rewrites the request's query string which appears after the first
4666 question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format string <fmt>.
4667 The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the request doesn't
4668 contain a question mark and the new value is not empty, then one is added at
4669 the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If a question mark was
4670 present, it will never be removed even if the value is empty. This can be
4671 used to add or remove parameters from the query string.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004672
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004673 See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004674
4675 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004676 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
4677 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004678
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004679http-request set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4680 This is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
4681 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP, but
4682 provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask source IP for
4683 privacy.
4684
4685 Arguments :
4686 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4687 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004688
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004689 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004690 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
4691 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
4692
4693 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
4694 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
4695
4696http-request set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4697
4698 This is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
4699 expression.
4700
4701 Arguments:
4702 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4703 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004704
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004705 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004706 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
4707 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
4708
4709 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long as
4710 the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source address to
4711 IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
4712
4713http-request set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4714
4715 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
4716 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
4717 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed both in
4718 decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only the 6 higher
4719 bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are always 0. This can
4720 be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers based on some
4721 information from the request.
4722
4723 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
4724
4725http-request set-uri <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4726
4727 This rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of format
4728 string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all replaced
4729 at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies, or to
4730 perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts between the
4731 path and the query string.
4732 See also "http-request set-path" and "http-request set-query".
4733
4734http-request set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4735
4736 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4737 inline.
4738
4739 Arguments:
4740 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
4741 scope. The scopes allowed are:
4742 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
4743 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4744 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
4745 (request and response)
4746 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
4747 processing
4748 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4749 processing
4750 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
4751 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
4752 and '_'.
4753
4754 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4755 followed by some converters.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004756
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004757 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004758 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004759
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004760http-request send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
4761 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004762
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004763 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
4764 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
4765 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
4766 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
4767 agent name must be used.
4768
4769 Arguments:
4770 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
4771
4772 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
4773 configuration.
4774
4775http-request silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4776
4777 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
4778 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
4779 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
4780 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
4781 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
4782 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
4783 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
4784 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
4785 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
4786 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
4787 action.
4788 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
4789 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
4790 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
4791 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
4792 you fully understand how it works.
4793
4794http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4795
4796 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks the request
4797 without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit" or
4798 "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the client
4799 is still connected, an HTTP error 500 (or optionally the status code
4800 specified as an argument to "deny_status") is returned so that the client
4801 does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags "PT".
4802 The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack when
4803 they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
4804 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the load
4805 on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
4806 developed robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the front
4807 firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections.
4808 See also the "silent-drop" action.
4809
4810http-request track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4811http-request track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4812http-request track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4813
4814 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules do
4815 not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of counters
4816 that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set in
4817 MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3,
4818 so the track-sc number is between 0 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first
4819 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
4820 table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking
4821 of the counters of the specified table as the second set. The first
4822 "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
4823 table as the third set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of
4824 counters for the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend
4825 ones. But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
4826
4827 Arguments :
4828 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described in
4829 section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming request or
4830 connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined, and used to
4831 select which table entry to update the counters.
4832
4833 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one, which
4834 is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All the counters
4835 for the matches and updates for the key will then be performed in
4836 that table until the session ends.
4837
4838 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table and if
4839 it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to that entry
4840 is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's counters are updated
4841 as often as possible, every time the session's counters are updated, and also
4842 systematically when the session ends. Counters are only updated for events
4843 that happen after the tracking has been started. As an exception, connection
4844 counters and request counters are systematically updated so that they reflect
4845 useful information.
4846
4847 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is counted
4848 for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not expire during
4849 that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance advantage over just
4850 checking the keys, because only one table lookup is performed for all ACL
4851 checks that make use of it.
4852
4853http-request unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4854
4855 This is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004856
4857 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004858 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004859
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004860http-request wait-for-handshake [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004861
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004862 This will delay the processing of the request until the SSL handshake
4863 happened. This is mostly useful to delay processing early data until we're
4864 sure they are valid.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004865
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004866
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004867http-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004868 Access control for Layer 7 responses
4869
4870 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4871 no | yes | yes | yes
4872
4873 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
4874 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
4875 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4876 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4877 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
4878 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
4879
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004880 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
4881 below.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004882
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004883 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004884
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004885 It is important to know that http-response rules are processed very early in
4886 the HTTP processing, before "rspdel" or "rsprep" or "rspadd" rules. That way,
4887 headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by almost all further
4888 ACL rules.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004889
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004890 Using "rspadd"/"rspdel"/"rsprep" to manipulate request headers is discouraged
4891 in newer versions (>= 1.5). But if you need to use regular expression to
4892 delete headers, you can still use "rspdel". Also please use
4893 "http-response deny" instead of "rspdeny".
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004894
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004895 Example:
4896 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004897
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004898 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004899
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004900 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
4901 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004902
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004903 Example:
4904 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004905
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004906 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004907
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004908 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
4909 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004910
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004911 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
4912 ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004913
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004914http-response add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004915
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004916 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4917 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4918 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4919 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
4920 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
4921 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
4922 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4923 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004924
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004925http-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004926
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004927 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
4928 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
4929 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
4930 example, or to pass some internal information.
4931 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
4932 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
4933 the resulting header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004934
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004935http-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004936
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004937 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
4938 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004939
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02004940http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004941
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004942 See section 10.2 about cache setup.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004943
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004944http-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004945
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004946 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
4947 converts it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
4948 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
4949 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
4950 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
4951 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and
4952 "capture response header" for more information.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004953
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004954 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing the
4955 string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
4956 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a
4957 previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
4958 keyword.
4959 If the slot <id> doesn't exist, then HAProxy fails parsing the configuration
4960 to prevent unexpected behavior at run time.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004961
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004962http-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004963
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004964 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4965 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4966 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4967 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4968 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4969 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004970
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004971http-response del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02004972
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004973 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02004974
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004975http-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02004976
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004977 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4978 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4979 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4980 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4981 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
4982 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004983
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004984http-response deny [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004985
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004986 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the response
4987 and emits an HTTP 502 error. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004988
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004989http-response redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004990
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004991 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
4992 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
4993 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible on
4994 the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When a
4995 redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server are
4996 closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02004997
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004998http-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
4999 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02005000
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005001 This matches the regular expression in all occurrences of header field <name>
5002 according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with the <replace-fmt> argument.
5003 Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt and work like in <fmt> arguments
5004 in "add-header". The match is only case-sensitive. It is important to
5005 understand that this action only considers whole header lines, regardless of
5006 the number of values they may contain. This usage is suited to headers
5007 naturally containing commas in their value, such as Set-Cookie, Expires and
5008 so on.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01005009
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005010 Example:
5011 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02005012
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005013 # applied to:
5014 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005015
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005016 # outputs:
5017 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005018
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005019 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005020
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005021http-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5022 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005023
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005024 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
5025 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the entire
5026 header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry more than
5027 one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005028
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005029 Example:
5030 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005031
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005032 # applied to:
5033 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005034
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005035 # outputs:
5036 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005037
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005038http-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5039http-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08005040
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005041 This action increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
5042 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
5043 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02005044
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005045http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02005046
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005047 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated by
5048 <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If an error
5049 occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01005050
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005051http-response send-spoe-group [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02005052
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005053 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
5054 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
5055 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
5056 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
5057 agent name must be used.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005058
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005059 Arguments:
5060 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005061
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005062 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
5063 configuration.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005064
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005065http-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005066
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005067 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
5068 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
5069 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005070
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005071http-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5072
5073 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
5074 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
5075 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
5076 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule can
5077 be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
5078
5079http-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
5080
5081 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
5082 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
5083 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
5084 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
5085 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry. It performs a
5086 lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
5087 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
5088 It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the stats socket, but can
5089 be triggered by an HTTP response.
5090
5091http-response set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5092
5093 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
5094 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
5095 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
5096 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed
5097 by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different
5098 route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on
5099 Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
5100
5101http-response set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5102
5103 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
5104 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
5105 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
5106 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
5107 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important
5108 than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
5109 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
5110 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
5111
5112http-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
5113 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5114
5115 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
5116 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
5117 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
5118 fallback.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08005119
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005120 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005121 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
5122 http-response set-status 431
5123 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
5124 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005125
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005126http-response set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005127
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005128 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
5129 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
5130 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
5131 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that
5132 only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are
5133 always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers
5134 based on some information from the request.
5135
5136 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
5137
5138http-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5139
5140 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
5141 inline.
5142
5143 Arguments:
5144 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5145 scope. The scopes allowed are:
5146 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
5147 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
5148 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
5149 (request and response)
5150 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
5151 processing
5152 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
5153 processing
5154 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5155 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
5156 and '_'.
5157
5158 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
5159 followed by some converters.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005160
5161 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005162 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005163
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005164http-response silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005165
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005166 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
5167 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
5168 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
5169 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
5170 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
5171 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
5172 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
5173 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
5174 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
5175 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
5176 action.
5177 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
5178 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
5179 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
5180 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
5181 you fully understand how it works.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005182
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005183http-response track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5184http-response track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5185http-response track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005186
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005187 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer
5188 to "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
5189 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make use
5190 of samples in response (e.g. res.*, status etc.) and samples below Layer 6
5191 (e.g. SSL-related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is not
5192 supported, haproxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
5193
5194http-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5195
5196 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-response set-var" for details
5197 about <var-name>.
5198
5199 Example:
5200 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
5201
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02005202
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005203http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
5204 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
5205
5206 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5207 yes | no | yes | yes
5208
5209 By default, a connection established between haproxy and the backend server
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005210 which is considered safe for reuse is moved back to the server's idle
5211 connections pool so that any other request can make use of it. This is the
5212 "safe" strategy below.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005213
5214 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
5215
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005216 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This mode
5217 may be enforced to cancel a different strategy inherited from
5218 a defaults section or for troubleshooting. For example, if an
5219 old bogus application considers that multiple requests over
5220 the same connection come from the same client and it is not
5221 possible to fix the application, it may be desirable to
5222 disable connection sharing in a single backend. An example of
5223 such an application could be an old haproxy using cookie
5224 insertion in tunnel mode and not checking any request past the
5225 first one.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005226
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005227 - "safe" : this is the default and the recommended strategy. The first
5228 request of a session is always sent over its own connection,
5229 and only subsequent requests may be dispatched over other
5230 existing connections. This ensures that in case the server
5231 closes the connection when the request is being sent, the
5232 browser can decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly
5233 equivalent to regular keep-alive, there should be no side
5234 effects.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005235
5236 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
5237 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
5238 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
5239 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
5240 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
5241 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
5242 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
5243 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02005244 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweighs the
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005245 downsides of rare connection failures.
5246
5247 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
5248 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
5249 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
5250 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
5251 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
5252 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005253 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005254 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
5255 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
5256 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
5257 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
5258 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
5259
5260 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005261 connection properties and compatibility. Specifically :
5262 - connections made with "usesrc" followed by a client-dependent value
5263 ("client", "clientip", "hdr_ip") are marked private and never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005264
5265 - connections sent to a server with a TLS SNI extension are marked private
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005266 and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005267
Lukas Tribusfd9b68c2018-10-27 20:06:59 +02005268 - connections with certain bogus authentication schemes (relying on the
5269 connection) like NTLM are detected, marked private and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005270
Lukas Tribus79a56932019-11-06 11:50:25 +01005271 A connection pool is involved and configurable with "pool-max-conn".
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005272
5273 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
5274 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
5275 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
5276
5277 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
5278
5279
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005280http-send-name-header [<header>]
5281 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005282 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5283 yes | no | yes | yes
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005284 Arguments :
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005285 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
5286
Willy Tarreaue0e32792019-10-07 14:58:02 +02005287 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the header field named <header>
5288 to be set to the name of the target server at the moment the request is about
5289 to be sent on the wire. Any existing occurrences of this header are removed.
5290 Upon retries and redispatches, the header field is updated to always reflect
5291 the server being attempted to connect to. Given that this header is modified
5292 very late in the connection setup, it may have unexpected effects on already
5293 modified headers. For example using it with transport-level header such as
5294 connection, content-length, transfer-encoding and so on will likely result in
5295 invalid requests being sent to the server. Additionally it has been reported
5296 that this directive is currently being used as a way to overwrite the Host
5297 header field in outgoing requests; while this trick has been known to work
5298 as a side effect of the feature for some time, it is not officially supported
5299 and might possibly not work anymore in a future version depending on the
5300 technical difficulties this feature induces. A long-term solution instead
5301 consists in fixing the application which required this trick so that it binds
5302 to the correct host name.
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005303
5304 See also : "server"
5305
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01005306id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02005307 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
5308 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5309 no | yes | yes | yes
5310 Arguments : none
5311
5312 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
5313 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
5314 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01005315
5316
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005317ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
5318 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
5319 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01005320 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005321
5322 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
5323 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
5324 and running).
5325
5326 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
5327 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
5328 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005329 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005330 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
5331
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005332 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
5333 "unless" condition is met.
5334
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03005335 Example:
5336 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
5337 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
5338 ignore-persist if url_static
5339
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005340 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
5341
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005342load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
5343 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
5344 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5345 yes | no | yes | yes
5346
5347 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
5348 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
5349 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005350 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005351 to tell haproxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
5352 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
5353 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
5354 over the stats socket and redirect output.
5355
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005356 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005357 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02005358 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005359
5360 Arguments:
5361 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
5362 named "server-state-file".
5363
5364 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
5365 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
5366 name is used as a file name.
5367
5368 none don't load any stat for this backend
5369
5370 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01005371 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
5372 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
5373 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005374 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01005375 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005376
5377 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
5378 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
5379
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005380 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005381
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005382 global
5383 stats socket /tmp/socket
5384 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005385
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005386 defaults
5387 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005388
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005389 backend bk
5390 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
5391 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005392
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005393
5394 Then one can run :
5395
5396 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
5397
5398 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
5399
5400 1
5401 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
5402 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5403 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5404
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005405 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005406
5407 global
5408 stats socket /tmp/socket
5409 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
5410
5411 defaults
5412 load-server-state-from-file local
5413
5414 backend bk
5415 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
5416 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
5417
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005418
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005419 Then one can run :
5420
5421 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
5422
5423 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
5424
5425 1
5426 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
5427 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5428 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5429
5430 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
5431 "show servers state"
5432
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005433
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005434log global
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02005435log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
5436 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005437no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005438 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
5439 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5440 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005441
5442 Prefix :
5443 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
5444 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
5445 prefix does not allow arguments.
5446
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005447 Arguments :
5448 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
5449 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
5450 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
5451 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
5452 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
5453 parameter.
5454
5455 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
5456 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
5457
5458 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
5459 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
5460 standard syslog port).
5461
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01005462 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
5463 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
5464 standard syslog port).
5465
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005466 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
5467 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
5468 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005469 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005470
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01005471 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may
5472 point to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered
5473 logs are used and one writev() call per log is performed. This
5474 is a bit expensive but acceptable for most workloads. Messages
5475 sent this way will not be truncated but may be dropped, in
5476 which case the DroppedLogs counter will be incremented. The
5477 writev() call is atomic even on pipes for messages up to
5478 PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least 512 and
5479 which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
5480 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other
5481 processes. Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file
5482 descriptor may also be directed to a file, but doing so will
5483 significantly slow haproxy down as non-blocking calls will be
5484 ignored. Also there will be no way to purge nor rotate this
5485 file without restarting the process. Note that the configured
5486 syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable for use
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005487 with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
5488 formats below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01005489
5490 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1"
5491 and "fd@2", see above.
5492
5493 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
5494 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005495
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02005496 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
5497 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
5498 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
5499 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
5500 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
5501 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
5502 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
5503 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
5504 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
5505 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005506 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02005507
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02005508 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
5509 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
5510 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
5511 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must
5512 be set with <sample_size> parameter.
5513
5514 <sample_size>
5515 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
5516 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
5517 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
5518 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
5519 (see also <ranges> parameter).
5520
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01005521 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
5522 one of the following :
5523
5524 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
5525 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
5526
5527 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
5528 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
5529
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01005530 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
5531 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
5532 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
5533 local log server. This format is compatible with what the
5534 systemd logger consumes.
5535
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005536 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
5537 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to
5538 be used in containers or during development, where the severity
5539 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
5540
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005541 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
5542
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01005543 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
5544 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
5545 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
5546
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005547 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
5548 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
5549 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
5550 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005551
5552 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
5553 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
5554 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02005555 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
5556 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
5557 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
5558 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
5559 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005560
5561 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
5562
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005563 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
5564 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
5565 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01005566
5567 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
5568 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
5569 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
5570 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
5571
5572 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
5573 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005574
5575 Example :
5576 log global
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005577 log stdout format short daemon # send log to systemd
5578 log stdout format raw daemon # send everything to stdout
5579 log stderr format raw daemon notice # send important events to stderr
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02005580 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
5581 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02005582 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005583
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005584
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005585log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01005586 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
5587 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5588 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005589
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01005590 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
5591 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
5592 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
5593 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
5594 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005595
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02005596 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format" and
5597 "option httplog" directives.
5598
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02005599log-format-sd <string>
5600 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
5601 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5602 yes | yes | yes | no
5603
5604 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
5605 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
5606 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
5607 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
5608 which covers the log format string in depth.
5609
5610 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
5611 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
5612
5613 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
5614 log format to "rfc5424".
5615
5616 Example :
5617 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
5618
5619
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01005620log-tag <string>
5621 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
5622 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5623 yes | yes | yes | yes
5624
5625 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
5626 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
5627 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
5628 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
5629 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
5630 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
5631 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
5632 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
5633 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005634
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005635max-keep-alive-queue <value>
5636 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
5637 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5638 yes | no | yes | yes
5639
5640 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
5641 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
5642 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
5643 servers.
5644
5645 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
5646 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
5647 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
5648 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
5649 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005650 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005651 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
5652 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
5653 picking a different server.
5654
5655 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
5656 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
5657 even if they have to be queued.
5658
5659 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
5660 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
5661
Olivier Houcharda4d4fdf2018-12-14 19:27:06 +01005662max-session-srv-conns <nb>
5663 Set the maximum number of outgoing connections we can keep idling for a given
5664 client session. The default is 5 (it precisely equals MAX_SRV_LIST which is
5665 defined at build time).
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005666
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005667maxconn <conns>
5668 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
5669 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5670 yes | yes | yes | no
5671 Arguments :
5672 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
5673 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
5674 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
5675 closes.
5676
5677 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
5678 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
5679 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
5680 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01005681 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
5682 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
5683 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
5684 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005685
5686 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
5687 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
5688 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
5689
Willy Tarreauc8d5b952019-02-27 17:25:52 +01005690 When this value is set to zero, which is the default, the global "maxconn"
5691 value is used.
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02005692
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005693 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
5694
5695
5696mode { tcp|http|health }
5697 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
5698 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5699 yes | yes | yes | yes
5700 Arguments :
5701 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
5702 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
5703 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
5704 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
5705
5706 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
5707 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
5708 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
5709 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
5710 brings HAProxy most of its value.
5711
5712 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005713 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
5714 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
5715 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
5716 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
5717 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
5718 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
5719 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005720
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005721 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
5722 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
5723 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005724
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005725 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005726 defaults http_instances
5727 mode http
5728
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005729 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005730
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005731
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01005732monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005733 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005734 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5735 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005736 Arguments :
5737 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
5738 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005739 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005740 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
5741 backend and its backup.
5742
5743 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
5744 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
5745 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
5746 servers in a list of backends.
5747
5748 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
5749 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
5750 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
5751 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
5752 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
5753 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
5754 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005755 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
5756 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005757
5758 Example:
5759 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005760 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005761 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
5762 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
5763 monitor-uri /site_alive
5764 monitor fail if site_dead
5765
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005766 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005767
5768
5769monitor-net <source>
5770 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
5771 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5772 yes | yes | yes | no
5773 Arguments :
5774 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
5775 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
5776 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
5777 followed by a mask.
5778
5779 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
5780 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005781 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005782 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
5783
5784 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
5785 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
5786 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
5787 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005788 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
5789 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
5790 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005791
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005792 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
5793 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
5794 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
5795 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
5796 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
5797 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005798
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01005799 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
5800 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005801
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005802 Example :
5803 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
5804 frontend www
5805 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
5806
5807 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
5808
5809
5810monitor-uri <uri>
5811 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
5812 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5813 yes | yes | yes | no
5814 Arguments :
5815 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
5816 health status instead of forwarding the request.
5817
5818 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
5819 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
5820 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
5821 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
5822 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
5823 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
5824 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
5825 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
5826
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01005827 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
5828 and even before any "http-request" or "block" rulesets. The only rulesets
5829 applied before are the tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it
5830 is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an
5831 upper component, nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of
5832 conditions using "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted
5833 to whatever check can be imagined (most often the number of available servers
5834 in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005835
5836 Example :
5837 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
5838 frontend www
5839 mode http
5840 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
5841
5842 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
5843
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005844
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005845option abortonclose
5846no option abortonclose
5847 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
5848 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5849 yes | no | yes | yes
5850 Arguments : none
5851
5852 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
5853 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
5854 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
5855 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005856 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005857 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
5858 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
5859 encountered while delivering the response.
5860
5861 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
5862 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
5863 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
5864 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
5865 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
5866 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005867 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005868 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005869 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005870 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
5871 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
5872 still not served and not pollute the servers.
5873
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005874 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
5875 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005876 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
5877 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
5878 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
5879 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
5880 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
5881 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005882 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005883
5884 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5885 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5886
5887 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
5888
5889
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005890option accept-invalid-http-request
5891no option accept-invalid-http-request
5892 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
5893 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5894 yes | yes | yes | no
5895 Arguments : none
5896
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005897 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005898 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005899 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005900 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
5901 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
5902 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
5903 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
5904 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01005905 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
5906 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
5907 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
5908 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005909 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005910 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02005911 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
5912 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
5913 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005914
5915 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
5916 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
5917 been confirmed.
5918
5919 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
5920 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01005921 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
5922 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005923 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
5924
5925 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5926 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5927
5928 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
5929 stats socket.
5930
5931
5932option accept-invalid-http-response
5933no option accept-invalid-http-response
5934 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
5935 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5936 yes | no | yes | yes
5937 Arguments : none
5938
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005939 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005940 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005941 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005942 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
5943 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
5944 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
5945 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
5946 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005947 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
5948 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
5949 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005950
5951 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
5952 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
5953 been confirmed.
5954
5955 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
5956 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
5957 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
5958 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
5959
5960 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5961 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5962
5963 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
5964 stats socket.
5965
5966
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005967option allbackups
5968no option allbackups
5969 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
5970 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5971 yes | no | yes | yes
5972 Arguments : none
5973
5974 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
5975 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
5976 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
5977 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
5978 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
5979 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
5980 order between the backup servers anymore.
5981
5982 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
5983 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
5984
5985 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5986 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5987
5988
5989option checkcache
5990no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08005991 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005992 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5993 yes | no | yes | yes
5994 Arguments : none
5995
5996 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
5997 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005998 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005999 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
6000 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02006001 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006002
6003 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006004 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006005 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006006 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
6007 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006008 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006009 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01006010 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
6011 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006012 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01006013 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
6014 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006015 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006016 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
6017 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
6018 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
6019 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
6020 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
6021 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
6022 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
6023 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
6024 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
6025
6026 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006027 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006028 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006029 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006030 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
6031
6032 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
6033 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006034 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006035 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006036
6037 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6038 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6039
6040
6041option clitcpka
6042no option clitcpka
6043 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
6044 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6045 yes | yes | yes | no
6046 Arguments : none
6047
6048 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
6049 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006050 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006051 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
6052
6053 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
6054 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
6055 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
6056 operating system and its tuning parameters.
6057
6058 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
6059 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
6060 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
6061 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
6062 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
6063
6064 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
6065
6066 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
6067 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
6068 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
6069
6070 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6071 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6072
6073 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
6074
6075
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006076option contstats
6077 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
6078 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6079 yes | yes | yes | no
6080 Arguments : none
6081
6082 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
6083 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
6084 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
6085 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01006086 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
6087 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
6088 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
6089 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
6090 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006091
6092
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006093option dontlog-normal
6094no option dontlog-normal
6095 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
6096 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6097 yes | yes | yes | no
6098 Arguments : none
6099
6100 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
6101 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
6102 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
6103 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
6104 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
6105 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
6106 logged.
6107
6108 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
6109 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
6110 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
6111
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006112 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006113 logging.
6114
6115
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006116option dontlognull
6117no option dontlognull
6118 Enable or disable logging of null connections
6119 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6120 yes | yes | yes | no
6121 Arguments : none
6122
6123 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
6124 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
6125 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
6126 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
6127 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
6128 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006129 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
6130 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
6131 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006132
6133 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006134 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006135 would not be logged.
6136
6137 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6138 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6139
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006140 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", and
6141 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006142
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006143
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006144option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006145 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
6146 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6147 yes | yes | yes | yes
6148 Arguments :
6149 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
6150 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006151 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006152 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006153
6154 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
6155 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
6156 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
6157 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
6158 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
6159 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
6160 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006161 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
6162 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
6163 possible that the client has already brought one.
6164
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006165 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006166 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006167 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006168 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006169 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006170 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006171
6172 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
6173 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
6174 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
6175 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
6176 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
6177 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
6178 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
6179
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006180 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
6181 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
6182 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
6183 are under the control of the end-user.
6184
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006185 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006186 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
6187 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006188 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
6189 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
6190 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006191
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006192 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006193 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
6194 frontend www
6195 mode http
6196 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
6197
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006198 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
6199 backend www
6200 mode http
6201 option forwardfor header X-Client
6202
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006203 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006204 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006205
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006206
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006207option http-buffer-request
6208no option http-buffer-request
6209 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
6210 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6211 yes | yes | yes | yes
6212 Arguments : none
6213
6214 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
6215 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
6216 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
6217 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
6218 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
6219 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
6220 body is received, or the request buffer is full, or the first chunk is
6221 complete in case of chunked encoding. It can have undesired side effects with
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01006222 some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered transmissions between
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006223 the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely not be used by
6224 default.
6225
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01006226 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006227
6228
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006229option http-ignore-probes
6230no option http-ignore-probes
6231 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
6232 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6233 yes | yes | yes | no
6234 Arguments : none
6235
6236 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
6237 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
6238 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
6239 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
6240 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
6241 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
6242 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
6243 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
6244 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006245 was received over a connection before it was closed;
6246 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006247 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
6248
6249 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
6250 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
6251 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
6252 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
6253 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
6254 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
6255 are often the only way to detect them.
6256
6257 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6258 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6259
6260 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
6261
6262
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006263option http-keep-alive
6264no option http-keep-alive
6265 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
6266 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6267 yes | yes | yes | yes
6268 Arguments : none
6269
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006270 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6271 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006272 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6273 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
6274 as "option http-server-close", "option httpclose" or "option http-tunnel".
6275 This option allows to set back the keep-alive mode, which can be useful when
6276 another mode was used in a defaults section.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006277
6278 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
6279 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006280 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
6281 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
6282 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
6283 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
6284 situations where this option may be useful :
6285
6286 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006287 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006288
6289 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
6290 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
6291
6292 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
6293 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
6294 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
6295 request.
6296
6297 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
6298 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006299 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
6300 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
6301 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006302
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006303 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
6304 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
6305 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
6306 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
6307 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
6308 not set.
6309
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01006310 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006311 http-server-close" or "option http-tunnel". When backend and frontend options
6312 differ, all of these 4 options have precedence over "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006313
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006314 See also : "option httpclose",, "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006315 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01006316 and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006317
6318
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02006319option http-no-delay
6320no option http-no-delay
6321 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
6322 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6323 yes | yes | yes | yes
6324 Arguments : none
6325
6326 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
6327 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
6328 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
6329 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
6330 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
6331 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
6332 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
6333 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
6334 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
6335 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
6336 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
6337 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
6338 affected.
6339
6340 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
6341 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
6342 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
6343 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
6344 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
6345 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
6346 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
6347 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
6348 latency environments.
6349
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006350 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
6351
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02006352
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006353option http-pretend-keepalive
6354no option http-pretend-keepalive
6355 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
6356 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02006357 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006358 Arguments : none
6359
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006360 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose", haproxy
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006361 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
6362 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
6363 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
6364 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
6365 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
6366 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
6367 consider the response complete.
6368
6369 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
6370 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
6371 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
6372 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006373 "option httpclose". That way the client gets a normal response and the
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006374 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
6375
6376 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
6377 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
6378 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
6379 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
6380 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
6381 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
6382 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
6383
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02006384 This option may be set in backend and listen sections. Using it in a frontend
6385 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during startup. It is
6386 a backend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
6387 frontend. This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will
6388 cause keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to
6389 the client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006390
6391 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6392 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6393
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006394 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", and
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006395 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006396
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006397
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006398option http-server-close
6399no option http-server-close
6400 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
6401 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6402 yes | yes | yes | yes
6403 Arguments : none
6404
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006405 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6406 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
6407 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6408 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006409 as "option http-server-close", "option httpclose" or "option http-tunnel".
6410 Setting "option http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the
6411 server side while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and
6412 pipelining on the client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client
6413 side (slow network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save
6414 server resources, similarly to "option httpclose". It also permits
6415 non-keepalive capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients
6416 if they conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note that some servers
6417 do not always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close"
6418 in the request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A
6419 workaround consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006420
6421 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
6422 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
6423 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
6424 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006425 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
6426 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006427
6428 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
6429 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006430 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option http-tunnel"
6431 or "option http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how
6432 this option combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006433
6434 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6435 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6436
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006437 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
6438 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006439
6440
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +01006441option http-tunnel (deprecated)
6442no option http-tunnel (deprecated)
6443 Disable or enable HTTP connection processing after first transaction.
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006444 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet4212a302018-09-21 10:42:19 +02006445 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006446 Arguments : none
6447
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +01006448 Warning : Because it cannot work in HTTP/2, this option is deprecated and it
6449 is only supported on legacy HTTP frontends. In HTX, it is ignored and a
6450 warning is emitted during HAProxy startup.
6451
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006452 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6453 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
6454 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6455 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006456 as "option http-server-close", "option httpclose" or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006457
6458 Option "http-tunnel" disables any HTTP processing past the first request and
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006459 the first response. This is the mode which was used by default in versions
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006460 1.0 to 1.5-dev21. It is the mode with the lowest processing overhead, which
6461 is normally not needed anymore unless in very specific cases such as when
6462 using an in-house protocol that looks like HTTP but is not compatible, or
6463 just to log one request per client in order to reduce log size. Note that
6464 everything which works at the HTTP level, including header parsing/addition,
6465 cookie processing or content switching will only work for the first request
6466 and will be ignored after the first response.
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006467
Christopher Faulet4212a302018-09-21 10:42:19 +02006468 This option may be set on frontend and listen sections. Using it on a backend
6469 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during the startup. It
6470 is a frontend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
6471 backend.
6472
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006473 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6474 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6475
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006476 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
6477 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006478
6479
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006480option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01006481no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006482 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
6483 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6484 yes | yes | yes | no
6485 Arguments : none
6486
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00006487 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006488 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
6489 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
6490 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
6491 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
6492 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
6493 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
6494
6495 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
6496 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01006497 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
6498 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
6499 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006500
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01006501 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
6502 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
6503 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
6504 front of an existing proxy.
6505
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006506 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
6507
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006508 See also : "option httpclose", and "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006509
6510
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02006511option http-use-htx
6512no option http-use-htx
6513 Switch to the new HTX internal representation for HTTP protocol elements
6514 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6515 yes | yes | yes | yes
6516 Arguments : none
6517
Christopher Faulet1d2b5862019-04-12 16:10:51 +02006518 Historically, the HTTP protocol is processed as-is. Inserting, deleting, or
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02006519 modifying a header field requires to rewrite the affected part in the buffer
Christopher Faulet1d2b5862019-04-12 16:10:51 +02006520 and to move the buffer's tail accordingly. This mode is known as the legacy
6521 HTTP mode. Since this principle has deep roots in haproxy, the HTTP/2
6522 protocol is converted to HTTP/1.1 before being processed this way. It also
6523 results in the inability to establish HTTP/2 connections to servers because
6524 of the loss of HTTP/2 semantics in the HTTP/1 representation.
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02006525
6526 HTX is the name of a totally new native internal representation for the HTTP
6527 protocol, that is agnostic to the version and aims at preserving semantics
6528 all along the chain. It relies on a fast parsing, tokenizing and indexing of
6529 the protocol elements so that no more memory moves are necessary and that
Christopher Faulet1d2b5862019-04-12 16:10:51 +02006530 most elements are directly accessed. It supports using either HTTP/1 or
6531 HTTP/2 on any side regardless of the other side's version. It also supports
6532 upgrades from TCP to HTTP and implicit ones from HTTP/1 to HTTP/2 (matching
6533 the HTTP/2 preface).
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02006534
Christopher Faulet1d2b5862019-04-12 16:10:51 +02006535 This option indicates that HTX needs to be used. Since the version 2.0-dev3,
6536 the HTX is the default mode. To switch back on the legacy HTTP mode, the
6537 option must be explicitly disabled using the "no" prefix. For prior versions,
6538 the feature has incomplete functional coverage, so it is not enabled by
6539 default.
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02006540
6541 See also : "mode http"
6542
6543
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006544option httpchk
6545option httpchk <uri>
6546option httpchk <method> <uri>
6547option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
6548 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
6549 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6550 yes | no | yes | yes
6551 Arguments :
6552 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
6553 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
6554 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
6555 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
6556 ones.
6557
6558 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
6559 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
6560 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
6561
6562 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
6563 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
6564 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
6565 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
6566 after "\r\n" following the version string.
6567
6568 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
6569 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
6570 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
6571 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
6572 the lack of any response.
6573
6574 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
6575
6576 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
6577 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
6578 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
6579
6580 Examples :
6581 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
6582 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
6583 backend https_relay
6584 mode tcp
6585 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
6586 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
6587
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09006588 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
6589 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
6590 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006591
6592
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006593option httpclose
6594no option httpclose
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006595 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006596 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6597 yes | yes | yes | yes
6598 Arguments : none
6599
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006600 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6601 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
6602 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6603 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006604 as "option http-server-close", "option httpclose" or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006605
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006606 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will close connections with the server
6607 and the client as soon as the request and the response are received. It will
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -05006608 also check if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction,
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006609 and will add one if missing. Any "Connection" header different from "close"
6610 will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006611
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006612 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
6613 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
6614 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006615
6616 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
6617 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01006618 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006619 "option http-keep-alive" or "option http-tunnel". Please check section 4
6620 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when frontend and
6621 backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006622
6623 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6624 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6625
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006626 See also : "option http-server-close" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006627
6628
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006629option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006630 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
6631 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01006632 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006633 Arguments :
6634 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
6635 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
6636 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006637 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006638 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006639
6640 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
6641 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
6642 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
6643 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
6644 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
6645 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
6646 ports.
6647
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01006648 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
6649 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006650
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02006651 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
6652
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006653 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006654
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006655
6656option http_proxy
6657no option http_proxy
6658 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
6659 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6660 yes | yes | yes | yes
6661 Arguments : none
6662
6663 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
6664 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
6665 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
6666 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
6667 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
6668
6669 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
6670 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01006671 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
6672 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006673
6674 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6675 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6676
6677 Example :
6678 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
6679 backend direct_forward
6680 option httpclose
6681 option http_proxy
6682
6683 See also : "option httpclose"
6684
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006685
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006686option independent-streams
6687no option independent-streams
6688 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006689 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6690 yes | yes | yes | yes
6691 Arguments : none
6692
6693 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
6694 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
6695 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
6696 receive data or not.
6697
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006698 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006699 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
6700 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
6701 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
6702 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
6703 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
6704 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
6705 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
6706 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
6707 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
6708 socket buffers.
6709
6710 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
6711 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
6712 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
6713 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
6714 slow lines, so use it with caution.
6715
Lukas Tribus745f15e2018-11-08 12:41:42 +01006716 Note: older versions used to call this setting "option independant-streams"
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006717 with a spelling mistake. This spelling is still supported but
6718 deprecated.
6719
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006720 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006721
6722
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02006723option ldap-check
6724 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
6725 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6726 yes | no | yes | yes
6727 Arguments : none
6728
6729 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
6730 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
6731 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
6732 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
6733
6734 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
6735 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
6736
6737 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
6738 configure it.
6739
6740 Example :
6741 option ldap-check
6742
6743 See also : "option httpchk"
6744
6745
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006746option external-check
6747 Use external processes for server health checks
6748 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6749 yes | no | yes | yes
6750
6751 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
6752 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
6753 command".
6754
6755 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
6756
6757 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
6758
6759
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006760option log-health-checks
6761no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006762 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006763 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6764 yes | no | yes | yes
6765 Arguments : none
6766
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006767 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
6768 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
6769 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006770
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006771 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
6772 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
6773 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
6774 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
6775 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
6776
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006777 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006778 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006779
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006780 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
6781 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
6782 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006783
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006784
6785option log-separate-errors
6786no option log-separate-errors
6787 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
6788 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6789 yes | yes | yes | no
6790 Arguments : none
6791
6792 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
6793 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
6794 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
6795 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
6796 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
6797 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
6798 provides very important information.
6799
6800 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
6801 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
6802 error logs.
6803
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006804 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006805 logging.
6806
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006807
6808option logasap
6809no option logasap
6810 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
6811 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6812 yes | yes | yes | no
6813 Arguments : none
6814
6815 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
6816 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
6817 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
6818 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
6819 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
6820 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
6821 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006822 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006823 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
6824 bytes are expected to be transferred.
6825
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01006826 Examples :
6827 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
6828 mode http
6829 option httplog
6830 option logasap
6831 log 192.168.2.200 local3
6832
6833 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
6834 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
6835 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
6836 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
6837
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006838 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006839 logging.
6840
6841
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02006842option mysql-check [ user <username> [ post-41 ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006843 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006844 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6845 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006846 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006847 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
6848 server.
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02006849 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006850
6851 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
6852 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006853 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006854 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
6855 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
6856 in the MySQL table, like this :
6857
6858 USE mysql;
6859 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
6860 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
6861
6862 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006863 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006864 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
6865 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
6866 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
6867 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
6868 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
6869 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
6870 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
6871
6872 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
6873 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006874
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02006875 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006876
6877 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
6878 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
6879 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
6880 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02006881 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
6882 server to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006883
6884 See also: "option httpchk"
6885
6886
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006887option nolinger
6888no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006889 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006890 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6891 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006892 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006893
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006894 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006895 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
6896 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
6897 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
6898 connections.
6899
6900 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
6901 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
6902 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
6903 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
6904 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
6905 this too.
6906
6907 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
6908 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
6909 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
6910
6911 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
6912 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
6913 for servers.
6914
6915 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6916 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6917
6918
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006919option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
6920 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
6921 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6922 yes | yes | yes | yes
6923 Arguments :
6924 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
6925 matching <network>
6926 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
6927 header name.
6928
6929 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
6930 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
6931 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
6932 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
6933 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
6934 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
6935 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
6936 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
6937 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
6938 possible that the client has already brought one.
6939
6940 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
6941 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
6942 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
6943 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
6944 header and requires different one.
6945
6946 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
6947 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
6948 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
6949 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
6950 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
6951 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
6952 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
6953
6954 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
6955 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
6956 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
6957 both are defined.
6958
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006959 Examples :
6960 # Original Destination address
6961 frontend www
6962 mode http
6963 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
6964
6965 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
6966 backend www
6967 mode http
6968 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
6969
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006970 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006971
6972
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006973option persist
6974no option persist
6975 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
6976 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6977 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006978 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006979
6980 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
6981 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
6982 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
6983 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
6984 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
6985 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
6986 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
6987 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
6988 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
6989 redirected to another valid server.
6990
6991 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6992 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6993
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01006994 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006995
6996
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01006997option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
6998 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
6999 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7000 yes | no | yes | yes
7001 Arguments :
7002 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
7003 PostgreSQL server.
7004
7005 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
7006 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
7007 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
7008 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
7009
7010 See also: "option httpchk"
7011
7012
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01007013option prefer-last-server
7014no option prefer-last-server
7015 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
7016 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7017 yes | no | yes | yes
7018 Arguments : none
7019
7020 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
7021 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
7022 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
7023 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
7024 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
7025 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
7026 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
7027 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
7028 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01007029 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
7030 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02007031 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required), when the load
7032 balancing algorithm is not deterministic. This is mandatory for use with the
7033 broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01007034 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
7035 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
7036 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01007037
7038 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7039 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7040
7041 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
7042
7043
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007044option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007045option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007046no option redispatch
7047 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
7048 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7049 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007050 Arguments :
7051 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
7052 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
7053 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007054 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007055 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007056 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007057 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
7058 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
7059 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
7060
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007061
7062 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
7063 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
7064 be able to access the service anymore.
7065
Willy Tarreau59884a62019-01-02 14:48:31 +01007066 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break cookie or
7067 consistent hash based persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007068
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007069 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007070 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
7071 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007072
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007073 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
7074 "redisp" keywords.
7075
7076 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7077 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7078
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01007079 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007080
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007081
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02007082option redis-check
7083 Use redis health checks for server testing
7084 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7085 yes | no | yes | yes
7086 Arguments : none
7087
7088 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
7089 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
7090 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
7091 find the "+PONG" response message.
7092
7093 Example :
7094 option redis-check
7095
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03007096 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02007097
7098
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007099option smtpchk
7100option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
7101 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
7102 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7103 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007104 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007105 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02007106 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESMTP). All other
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007107 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
7108
7109 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
7110 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
7111 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
7112
7113 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
7114 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
7115 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
7116 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
7117 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
7118 dead server.
7119
7120 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
7121 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007122 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007123 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
7124
7125 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
7126 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
7127 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
7128 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02007129 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007130
7131 Example :
7132 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
7133
7134 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
7135
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007136
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02007137option socket-stats
7138no option socket-stats
7139
7140 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
7141 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7142 yes | yes | yes | no
7143
7144 Arguments : none
7145
7146
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007147option splice-auto
7148no option splice-auto
7149 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
7150 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7151 yes | yes | yes | yes
7152 Arguments : none
7153
7154 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
7155 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007156 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007157 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007158 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007159 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
7160 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
7161 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
7162 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
7163
7164 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
7165 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
7166 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
7167 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
7168 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
7169 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
7170 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
7171 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
7172 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
7173 keyword.
7174
7175 Example :
7176 option splice-auto
7177
7178 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7179 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7180
7181 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
7182 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
7183
7184
7185option splice-request
7186no option splice-request
7187 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
7188 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7189 yes | yes | yes | yes
7190 Arguments : none
7191
7192 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007193 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007194 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
7195 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
7196 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
7197 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
7198
7199 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
7200
7201 Example :
7202 option splice-request
7203
7204 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7205 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7206
7207 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
7208 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
7209
7210
7211option splice-response
7212no option splice-response
7213 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
7214 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7215 yes | yes | yes | yes
7216 Arguments : none
7217
7218 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007219 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007220 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
7221 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
7222 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
7223 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
7224
7225 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
7226
7227 Example :
7228 option splice-response
7229
7230 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7231 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7232
7233 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
7234 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
7235
7236
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01007237option spop-check
7238 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
7239 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7240 no | no | no | yes
7241 Arguments : none
7242
7243 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
7244 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
7245 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
7246 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
7247
7248 Example :
7249 option spop-check
7250
7251 See also : "option httpchk"
7252
7253
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007254option srvtcpka
7255no option srvtcpka
7256 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
7257 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7258 yes | no | yes | yes
7259 Arguments : none
7260
7261 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
7262 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007263 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007264 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
7265
7266 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
7267 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
7268 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
7269 operating system and its tuning parameters.
7270
7271 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
7272 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
7273 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
7274 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
7275 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
7276
7277 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
7278
7279 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
7280 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
7281 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
7282
7283 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7284 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7285
7286 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
7287
7288
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007289option ssl-hello-chk
7290 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
7291 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7292 yes | no | yes | yes
7293 Arguments : none
7294
7295 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
7296 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
7297 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
7298 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
7299 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
7300 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
7301 hello message.
7302
7303 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
7304 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
7305 messages, which is appreciable.
7306
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007307 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
7308 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
7309 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007310
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007311 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
7312
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007313
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007314option tcp-check
7315 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
7316 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7317 yes | no | yes | yes
7318
7319 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
7320 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
7321
7322 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
7323 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
7324 attempt, which remains the default mode.
7325
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007326 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007327 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
7328 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
7329 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
7330 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
7331 only.
7332
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007333 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007334 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
7335 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
7336 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
7337 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
7338
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007339 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007340 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
7341 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007342 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007343 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
7344 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
7345 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
7346 the respective protocols.
7347 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007348 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007349
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007350 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the
7351 script.
7352
7353 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
7354 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr
7355 in debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting.
7356 The "comment" is of course optional.
7357
7358
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007359 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007360 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007361 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007362 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007363
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007364 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007365 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007366 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007367
7368 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
7369 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007370 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007371 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007372 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007373 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02007374 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007375 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007376 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
7377 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007378 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007379 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
7380 tcp-check expect string +OK
7381
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007382 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007383 (send many headers before analyzing)
7384 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007385 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007386 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
7387 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
7388 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
7389 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007390 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007391
7392
7393 See also : "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send"
7394
7395
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007396option tcp-smart-accept
7397no option tcp-smart-accept
7398 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
7399 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7400 yes | yes | yes | no
7401 Arguments : none
7402
7403 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
7404 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
7405 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
7406 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
7407 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
7408 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
7409
7410 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
7411 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
7412 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
7413 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
7414
7415 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
7416 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
7417 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007418 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007419
7420 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
7421 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
7422 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
7423
7424 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
7425 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
7426 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
7427
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02007428 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
7429
7430
7431option tcp-smart-connect
7432no option tcp-smart-connect
7433 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
7434 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7435 yes | no | yes | yes
7436 Arguments : none
7437
7438 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
7439 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
7440 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
7441 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
7442 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
7443
7444 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
7445 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
7446 complex.
7447
7448 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
7449 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
7450 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
7451
7452 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7453 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7454
7455 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
7456
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007457
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007458option tcpka
7459 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
7460 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7461 yes | yes | yes | yes
7462 Arguments : none
7463
7464 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
7465 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007466 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007467 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
7468
7469 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
7470 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
7471 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
7472 operating system and its tuning parameters.
7473
7474 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
7475 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
7476 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
7477 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
7478 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
7479
7480 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
7481
7482 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
7483 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
7484 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
7485 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
7486 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
7487 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
7488 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
7489 backends.
7490
7491 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
7492
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007493
7494option tcplog
7495 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
7496 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01007497 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007498 Arguments : none
7499
7500 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
7501 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
7502 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
7503 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
7504 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
7505 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
7506 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
7507 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
7508
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02007509 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
7510
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007511 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007512
7513
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007514option transparent
7515no option transparent
7516 Enable client-side transparent proxying
7517 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01007518 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007519 Arguments : none
7520
7521 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
7522 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
7523 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
7524 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
7525 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
7526 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
7527 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
7528 appropriate server.
7529
7530 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
7531 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
7532
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01007533 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007534 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007535
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007536
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007537external-check command <command>
7538 Executable to run when performing an external-check
7539 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7540 yes | no | yes | yes
7541
7542 Arguments :
7543 <command> is the external command to run
7544
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007545 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
7546
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01007547 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007548
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01007549 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
7550 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
7551 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
7552 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
7553 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
7554 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007555
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01007556 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
7557
7558 Environment variables :
7559 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
7560 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
7561
7562 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
7563
7564 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
7565
7566 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
7567 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
7568 for a UNIX socket).
7569
7570 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
7571
7572 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
7573
7574 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
7575
7576 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
7577
7578 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
7579
7580 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
7581 socket).
7582
7583 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
7584 the command may be set using "external-check path".
7585
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +02007586 See also "2.3. Environment variables" for other variables.
7587
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007588 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
7589 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
7590 failed.
7591
7592 Example :
7593 external-check command /bin/true
7594
7595 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
7596
7597
7598external-check path <path>
7599 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
7600 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7601 yes | no | yes | yes
7602
7603 Arguments :
7604 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
7605
7606 The default path is "".
7607
7608 Example :
7609 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
7610
7611 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
7612 "external-check command"
7613
7614
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007615persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007616persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007617 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
7618 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7619 yes | no | yes | yes
7620 Arguments :
7621 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02007622 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
7623 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007624
7625 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
7626 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007627 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007628 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
7629 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
7630 forwarded to this server.
7631
7632 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
7633 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
7634 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007635 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007636 a single "listen" section.
7637
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02007638 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
7639 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
7640 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
7641
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007642 Example :
7643 listen tse-farm
7644 bind :3389
7645 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
7646 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
7647 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
7648 # apply RDP cookie persistence
7649 persist rdp-cookie
7650 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02007651 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007652 balance rdp-cookie
7653 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
7654 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
7655
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09007656 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
7657 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007658
7659
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007660rate-limit sessions <rate>
7661 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
7662 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7663 yes | yes | yes | no
7664 Arguments :
7665 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
7666 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
7667
7668 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
7669 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
7670 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
7671 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
7672 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
7673 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
7674
7675 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
7676 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
7677 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
7678 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
7679
7680 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
7681 listen smtp
7682 mode tcp
7683 bind :25
7684 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +02007685 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007686
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02007687 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
7688 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
7689 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007690
7691 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
7692
7693
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007694redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7695redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7696redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007697 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
7698 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7699 no | yes | yes | yes
7700
7701 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01007702 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007703
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007704 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007705 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007706 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
7707 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
7708 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007709
7710 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
7711 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
7712 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
7713 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
7714 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007715 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
7716 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
7717 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
7718 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007719
7720 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
7721 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
7722 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
7723 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
7724 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
7725 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007726 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007727 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007728 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
7729 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
7730 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007731
7732 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01007733 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
7734 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
7735 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +02007736 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01007737 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
7738 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
7739 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
7740 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007741
7742 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007743 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007744
7745 - "drop-query"
7746 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
7747 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
7748 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
7749 with a location-type redirect.
7750
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01007751 - "append-slash"
7752 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
7753 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
7754 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
7755 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
7756
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007757 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
7758 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
7759 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
7760 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
7761 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
7762 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
7763 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
7764
7765 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
7766 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
7767 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
7768 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
7769 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
7770 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
7771 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007772
7773 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
7774 acl clear dst_port 80
7775 acl secure dst_port 8080
7776 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007777 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01007778 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007779 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
7780
7781 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01007782 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
7783 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
7784 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007785 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007786
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01007787 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
7788 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
7789 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
7790
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007791 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01007792 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007793
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007794 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +02007795 http-request redirect code 301 location \
7796 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
7797 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007798
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007799 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007800
7801
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007802redisp (deprecated)
7803redispatch (deprecated)
7804 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
7805 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7806 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007807 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007808
7809 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
7810 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
7811 be able to access the service anymore.
7812
7813 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
7814 redistribute them to a working server.
7815
7816 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
7817 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
7818 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007819
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007820 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
7821 "option redispatch" instead.
7822
7823 See also : "option redispatch"
7824
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007825
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02007826reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007827 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
7828 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7829 no | yes | yes | yes
7830 Arguments :
7831 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7832 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007833 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007834
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01007835 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7836 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7837
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007838 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
7839 the last header of an HTTP request.
7840
7841 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7842 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7843 responses.
7844
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01007845 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
7846 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
7847 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
7848
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007849 See also: "rspadd", "http-request", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation,
7850 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007851
7852
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02007853reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
7854reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007855 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
7856 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7857 no | yes | yes | yes
7858 Arguments :
7859 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7860 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7861 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7862 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7863 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7864 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
7865 ignores case.
7866
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007867 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7868 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7869
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007870 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7871 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
7872 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
7873 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007874 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007875
7876 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7877 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
7878
7879 Example :
7880 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
7881 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
7882 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
7883
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007884 See also: "reqdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about HTTP header
7885 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007886
7887
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02007888reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
7889reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007890 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
7891 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7892 no | yes | yes | yes
7893 Arguments :
7894 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7895 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7896 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7897 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7898 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
7899 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
7900
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007901 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7902 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7903
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007904 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
7905 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
7906 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
7907 next servers.
7908
7909 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7910 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7911 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
7912
7913 Example :
7914 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
7915 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
7916 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
7917
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007918 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", "http-request", section 6 about
7919 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007920
7921
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02007922reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
7923reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007924 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
7925 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7926 no | yes | yes | yes
7927 Arguments :
7928 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7929 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7930 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7931 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7932 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7933 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
7934 case.
7935
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007936 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7937 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7938
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007939 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7940 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
7941 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
7942 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007943 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007944
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007945 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007946 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007947 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007948
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007949 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7950 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
7951
7952 Example :
7953 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
7954 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
7955 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
7956
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007957 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about
7958 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007959
7960
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02007961reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
7962reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007963 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
7964 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7965 no | yes | yes | yes
7966 Arguments :
7967 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7968 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7969 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7970 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7971 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7972 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
7973 case.
7974
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007975 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7976 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7977
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007978 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7979 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
7980 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
7981 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
7982
7983 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7984 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
7985
7986 Example :
7987 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
7988 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
7989 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
7990 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
7991
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007992 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about
7993 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007994
7995
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02007996reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
7997reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007998 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
7999 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8000 no | yes | yes | yes
8001 Arguments :
8002 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
8003 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
8004 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
8005 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
8006 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
8007 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
8008
8009 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
8010 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
8011 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
8012 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008013 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008014
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01008015 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8016 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8017
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008018 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
8019 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
8020 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
8021
8022 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
8023 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
8024 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
8025 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
8026 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
8027
8028 Example :
8029 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04008030 reqrep ^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008031 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
8032 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
8033
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008034 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", "tune.bufsize", "http-request",
8035 section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008036
8037
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02008038reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
8039reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008040 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
8041 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8042 no | yes | yes | yes
8043 Arguments :
8044 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
8045 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
8046 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
8047 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
8048 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
8049 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
8050 ignores case.
8051
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01008052 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8053 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8054
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008055 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
8056 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008057 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
8058 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
8059 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008060 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
8061 not set.
8062
8063 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
8064 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
8065 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
8066 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
8067 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
8068
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01008069 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008070 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavor of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008071 # block all others.
8072 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
8073 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
8074
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01008075 # block bad guys
8076 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
8077 reqitarpit . if badguys
8078
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008079 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", "http-request", section 6
8080 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008081
8082
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02008083retries <value>
8084 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
8085 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8086 yes | no | yes | yes
8087 Arguments :
8088 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
8089 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
8090 default value is 3.
8091
8092 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
8093 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
8094 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
8095
8096 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008097 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
8098 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02008099
8100 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
8101 server even if a cookie references a different server.
8102
8103 See also : "option redispatch"
8104
8105
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02008106retry-on [list of keywords]
8107 Specify when to attempt to automatically retry a failed request
8108 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8109 yes | no | yes | yes
8110 Arguments :
8111 <keywords> is a list of keywords or HTTP status codes, each representing a
8112 type of failure event on which an attempt to retry the request
8113 is desired. Please read the notes at the bottom before changing
8114 this setting. The following keywords are supported :
8115
8116 none never retry
8117
8118 conn-failure retry when the connection or the SSL handshake failed
8119 and the request could not be sent. This is the default.
8120
8121 empty-response retry when the server connection was closed after part
8122 of the request was sent, and nothing was received from
8123 the server. This type of failure may be caused by the
8124 request timeout on the server side, poor network
8125 condition, or a server crash or restart while
8126 processing the request.
8127
Olivier Houcharde3249a92019-05-03 23:01:47 +02008128 junk-response retry when the server returned something not looking
8129 like a complete HTTP response. This includes partial
8130 responses headers as well as non-HTTP contents. It
8131 usually is a bad idea to retry on such events, which
8132 may be caused a configuration issue (wrong server port)
8133 or by the request being harmful to the server (buffer
8134 overflow attack for example).
8135
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02008136 response-timeout the server timeout stroke while waiting for the server
8137 to respond to the request. This may be caused by poor
8138 network condition, the reuse of an idle connection
8139 which has expired on the path, or by the request being
8140 extremely expensive to process. It generally is a bad
8141 idea to retry on such events on servers dealing with
8142 heavy database processing (full scans, etc) as it may
8143 amplify denial of service attacks.
8144
Olivier Houchard865d8392019-05-03 22:46:27 +02008145 0rtt-rejected retry requests which were sent over early data and were
8146 rejected by the server. These requests are generally
8147 considered to be safe to retry.
8148
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02008149 <status> any HTTP status code among "404" (Not Found), "408"
8150 (Request Timeout), "425" (Too Early), "500" (Server
8151 Error), "501" (Not Implemented), "502" (Bad Gateway),
8152 "503" (Service Unavailable), "504" (Gateway Timeout).
8153
Olivier Houchardddf0e032019-05-10 18:05:40 +02008154 all-retryable-errors
8155 retry request for any error that are considered
8156 retryable. This currently activates "conn-failure",
8157 "empty-response", "junk-response", "response-timeout",
8158 "0rtt-rejected", "500", "502", "503", and "504".
8159
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02008160 Using this directive replaces any previous settings with the new ones; it is
8161 not cumulative.
8162
8163 Please note that using anything other than "none" and "conn-failure" requires
8164 to allocate a buffer and copy the whole request into it, so it has memory and
8165 performance impacts. Requests not fitting in a single buffer will never be
8166 retried (see the global tune.bufsize setting).
8167
8168 You have to make sure the application has a replay protection mechanism built
8169 in such as a unique transaction IDs passed in requests, or that replaying the
8170 same request has no consequence, or it is very dangerous to use any retry-on
8171 value beside "conn-failure" and "none". Static file servers and caches are
8172 generally considered safe against any type of retry. Using a status code can
8173 be useful to quickly leave a server showing an abnormal behavior (out of
8174 memory, file system issues, etc), but in this case it may be a good idea to
8175 immediately redispatch the connection to another server (please see "option
8176 redispatch" for this). Last, it is important to understand that most causes
8177 of failures are the requests themselves and that retrying a request causing a
8178 server to misbehave will often make the situation even worse for this server,
8179 or for the whole service in case of redispatch.
8180
8181 Unless you know exactly how the application deals with replayed requests, you
8182 should not use this directive.
8183
8184 The default is "conn-failure".
8185
8186 See also: "retries", "option redispatch", "tune.bufsize"
8187
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02008188rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008189 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
8190 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8191 no | yes | yes | yes
8192 Arguments :
8193 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
8194 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008195 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008196
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01008197 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8198 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8199
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008200 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
8201 the last header of an HTTP response.
8202
8203 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
8204 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
8205 responses.
8206
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008207 See also: "rspdel" "reqadd", "http-response", section 6 about HTTP header
8208 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008209
8210
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02008211rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
8212rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008213 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
8214 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8215 no | yes | yes | yes
8216 Arguments :
8217 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
8218 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
8219 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
8220 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
8221 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
8222 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
8223 ignores case.
8224
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01008225 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8226 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8227
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008228 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
8229 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02008230 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008231 client.
8232
8233 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
8234 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
8235 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
8236
8237 Example :
8238 # remove the Server header from responses
Willy Tarreau5e80e022013-05-25 08:31:25 +02008239 rspidel ^Server:.*
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008240
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008241 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", "http-response", section 6 about
8242 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008243
8244
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02008245rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
8246rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008247 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
8248 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8249 no | yes | yes | yes
8250 Arguments :
8251 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
8252 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
8253 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
8254 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
8255 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
8256 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
8257 ignores case.
8258
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01008259 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8260 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8261
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008262 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
8263 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
8264 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
8265 case-sensitive.
8266
8267 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008268 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
8269 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
8270 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008271
8272 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
8273 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
8274
8275 Example :
8276 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
8277 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
8278
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008279 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", "http-response", section 6 about
8280 HTTP header manipulation and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008281
8282
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02008283rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
8284rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008285 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
8286 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8287 no | yes | yes | yes
8288 Arguments :
8289 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
8290 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
8291 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
8292 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
8293 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
8294 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
8295 ignores case.
8296
8297 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
8298 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
8299 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
8300 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008301 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008302
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01008303 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8304 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8305
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008306 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
8307 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
8308 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
8309
8310 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
8311 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
8312 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
8313 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
8314 are not case-sensitive.
8315
8316 Example :
8317 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
8318 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
8319
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008320 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", "http-response", section 6 about
8321 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008322
8323
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01008324server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008325 Declare a server in a backend
8326 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8327 no | no | yes | yes
8328 Arguments :
8329 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008330 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008331 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008332
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01008333 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
8334 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
8335 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
8336 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02008337 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
8338 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
8339 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
8340 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
8341 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008342 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
8343 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
8344 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
8345 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
8346 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
8347 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
8348 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02008349 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02008350 - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
8351 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
8352 backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
8353 one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
8354 received socket as the client FD. Should be used
8355 carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02008356 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
8357 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +01008358 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
8359 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008360
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008361 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008362 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
8363 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
8364 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
8365 adding this value to the client's port.
8366
8367 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
8368 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008369 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008370
8371 Examples :
8372 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
8373 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008374 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02008375 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
8376 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
8377 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008378
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02008379 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
8380 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
8381 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
8382 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
8383 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
8384
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008385 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
8386 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008387
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008388server-state-file-name [<file>]
8389 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
8390 this backend. It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file"
8391 is set to "local". When <file> is not provided or if this directive is not
8392 set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a slash '/', then it is
8393 considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is concatenated to the
8394 global directive "server-state-file-base".
8395
8396 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
8397 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
8398
8399 global
8400 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
8401
8402 backend bk
8403 load-server-state-from-file
8404
8405 See also: "server-state-file-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
8406 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008407
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02008408server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
8409 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
8410 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
8411 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8412 no | no | yes | yes
8413
8414 Arguments:
8415 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
8416
8417 <num | range>
8418 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
8419 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
8420 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
8421 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
8422
8423 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
8424
8425 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
8426
8427 <params*>
8428 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
8429 keyword.
8430
8431 Examples:
8432 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
8433 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
8434 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
8435
8436 # or
8437 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
8438
8439 # would be equivalent to:
8440 server srv1 google.com:80 check
8441 server srv2 google.com:80 check
8442 server srv3 google.com:80 check
8443
8444
8445
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008446source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008447source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01008448source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008449 Set the source address for outgoing connections
8450 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8451 yes | no | yes | yes
8452 Arguments :
8453 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
8454 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008455
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008456 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008457 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
8458 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
8459 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
8460 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
8461 supported prefixes are :
8462 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
8463 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
8464 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02008465 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02008466 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
8467 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008468
8469 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
8470 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02008471 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
8472 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
8473 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008474
8475 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
8476 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
8477 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
8478 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
8479 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
8480 <addr>.
8481
8482 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
8483 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
8484 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
8485 port.
8486
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008487 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
8488 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
8489 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
8490 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01008491 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008492 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
8493 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
8494 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
8495 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
8496 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
8497 HTTP header.
8498
8499 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
8500 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008501 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008502 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
8503 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
8504 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
8505 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
8506 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
8507 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
8508 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
8509
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01008510 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
8511 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
8512 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
8513 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
8514 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
8515 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
8516
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008517 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
8518 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
8519 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
8520 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
8521
8522 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
8523 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
8524 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
8525 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
8526 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
8527 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
8528
8529 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
8530 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
8531 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
8532 there are two methods :
8533
8534 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
8535 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
8536 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
8537 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
8538 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
8539 of the client ranges may be used.
8540
8541 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
8542 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
8543 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
8544 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
8545 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
8546 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
8547 same session.
8548
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008549 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
8550 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
8551 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008552 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008553
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +02008554 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
8555
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008556 Examples :
8557 backend private
8558 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
8559 source 192.168.1.200
8560
8561 backend transparent_ssl1
8562 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
8563 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
8564
8565 backend transparent_ssl2
8566 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
8567 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
8568 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
8569
8570 backend transparent_ssl3
8571 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
8572 # is more conntrack-friendly.
8573 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
8574
8575 backend transparent_smtp
8576 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
8577 # with Tproxy version 4.
8578 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
8579
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008580 backend transparent_http
8581 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
8582 # proxy.
8583 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
8584
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008585 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008586 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
8587
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008588
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008589srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
8590 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
8591 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8592 yes | no | yes | yes
8593 Arguments :
8594 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8595 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8596 as explained at the top of this document.
8597
8598 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
8599 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
8600 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
8601 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
8602 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
8603 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
8604 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
8605
8606 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
8607 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
8608 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
8609 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
8610 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008611 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008612 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008613 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008614
8615 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
8616 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
8617 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
8618 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
8619 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
8620 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
8621
8622 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
8623 Please use "timeout server" instead.
8624
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008625 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout client" and
8626 "clitimeout".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008627
8628
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008629stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
8630 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
8631 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008632 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008633
8634 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
8635 matched.
8636
8637 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
8638 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
8639
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008640 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8641 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008642 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008643
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01008644 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
8645 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
8646 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
8647 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008648
8649 Example :
8650 # statistics admin level only for localhost
8651 backend stats_localhost
8652 stats enable
8653 stats admin if LOCALHOST
8654
8655 Example :
8656 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
8657 backend stats_auth
8658 stats enable
8659 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
8660 stats admin if TRUE
8661
8662 Example :
8663 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
8664 userlist stats-auth
8665 group admin users admin
8666 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
8667 group readonly users haproxy
8668 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
8669
8670 backend stats_auth
8671 stats enable
8672 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
8673 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
8674 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
8675 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
8676
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008677 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
8678 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
8679 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008680
8681
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008682stats auth <user>:<passwd>
8683 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
8684 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008685 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008686 Arguments :
8687 <user> is a user name to grant access to
8688
8689 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
8690
8691 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
8692 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
8693 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
8694 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
8695 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
8696 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
8697
8698 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
8699 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
8700 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02008701 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008702
8703 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
8704 report using "stats scope".
8705
8706 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8707 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8708 unobvious parameters.
8709
8710 Example :
8711 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8712 backend public_www
8713 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8714 stats enable
8715 stats hide-version
8716 stats scope .
8717 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008718 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008719 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8720 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8721
8722 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8723 backend private_monitoring
8724 stats enable
8725 stats uri /admin?stats
8726 stats refresh 5s
8727
8728 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
8729
8730
8731stats enable
8732 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
8733 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008734 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008735 Arguments : none
8736
8737 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
8738 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
8739 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
8740 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
8741 - stats auth : no authentication
8742 - stats scope : no restriction
8743
8744 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8745 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8746 unobvious parameters.
8747
8748 Example :
8749 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8750 backend public_www
8751 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8752 stats enable
8753 stats hide-version
8754 stats scope .
8755 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008756 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008757 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8758 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8759
8760 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8761 backend private_monitoring
8762 stats enable
8763 stats uri /admin?stats
8764 stats refresh 5s
8765
8766 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8767
8768
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008769stats hide-version
8770 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008771 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008772 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008773 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008774
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008775 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
8776 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
8777 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
8778 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
8779 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
8780 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008781
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02008782 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8783 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8784 unobvious parameters.
8785
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008786 Example :
8787 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8788 backend public_www
8789 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02008790 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008791 stats hide-version
8792 stats scope .
8793 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008794 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008795 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8796 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008797
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008798 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8799 backend private_monitoring
8800 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008801 stats uri /admin?stats
8802 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01008803
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008804 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008805
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01008806
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02008807stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
8808 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8809 Access control for statistics
8810
8811 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8812 no | no | yes | yes
8813
8814 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
8815 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
8816 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
8817 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
8818 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
8819 should be asked to enter a username and password.
8820
8821 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
8822 instance.
8823
8824 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
8825 about ACL usage.
8826
8827
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008828stats realm <realm>
8829 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
8830 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008831 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008832 Arguments :
8833 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
8834 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
8835 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
8836
8837 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
8838 using a backslash ('\').
8839
8840 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
8841 only related to authentication.
8842
8843 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8844 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8845 unobvious parameters.
8846
8847 Example :
8848 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8849 backend public_www
8850 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8851 stats enable
8852 stats hide-version
8853 stats scope .
8854 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008855 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008856 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8857 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8858
8859 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8860 backend private_monitoring
8861 stats enable
8862 stats uri /admin?stats
8863 stats refresh 5s
8864
8865 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
8866
8867
8868stats refresh <delay>
8869 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
8870 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008871 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008872 Arguments :
8873 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
8874 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
8875 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
8876 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
8877 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
8878 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
8879
8880 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
8881 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
8882 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
8883 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
8884
8885 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8886 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8887 unobvious parameters.
8888
8889 Example :
8890 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8891 backend public_www
8892 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8893 stats enable
8894 stats hide-version
8895 stats scope .
8896 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008897 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008898 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8899 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8900
8901 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8902 backend private_monitoring
8903 stats enable
8904 stats uri /admin?stats
8905 stats refresh 5s
8906
8907 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8908
8909
8910stats scope { <name> | "." }
8911 Enable statistics and limit access scope
8912 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008913 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008914 Arguments :
8915 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
8916 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
8917 section in which the statement appears.
8918
8919 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
8920 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
8921 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
8922 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
8923 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
8924 exists.
8925
8926 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8927 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8928 unobvious parameters.
8929
8930 Example :
8931 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8932 backend public_www
8933 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8934 stats enable
8935 stats hide-version
8936 stats scope .
8937 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008938 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008939 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8940 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8941
8942 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8943 backend private_monitoring
8944 stats enable
8945 stats uri /admin?stats
8946 stats refresh 5s
8947
8948 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8949
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008950
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008951stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008952 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
8953 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008954 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008955
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008956 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008957 description from global section is automatically used instead.
8958
8959 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
8960 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
8961
8962 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8963 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008964 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008965
8966 Example :
8967 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8968 backend private_monitoring
8969 stats enable
8970 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
8971 stats uri /admin?stats
8972 stats refresh 5s
8973
8974 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
8975 global section.
8976
8977
8978stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008979 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
8980 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8981 yes | yes | yes | yes
8982 Arguments : none
8983
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008984 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008985 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
8986 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
8987 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
8988 - IP (socket, server)
8989 - cookie (backend, server)
8990
8991 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8992 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008993 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008994
8995 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
8996
8997
8998stats show-node [ <name> ]
8999 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
9000 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009001 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009002 Arguments:
9003 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
9004 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
9005
9006 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
9007 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009008 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009009
9010 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9011 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9012 unobvious parameters.
9013
9014 Example:
9015 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9016 backend private_monitoring
9017 stats enable
9018 stats show-node Europe-1
9019 stats uri /admin?stats
9020 stats refresh 5s
9021
9022 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
9023 section.
9024
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009025
9026stats uri <prefix>
9027 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
9028 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009029 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009030 Arguments :
9031 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
9032 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
9033 query string.
9034
9035 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
9036 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
9037 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
9038 possible to reach it in the application.
9039
9040 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009041 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009042 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
9043 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
9044 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
9045 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
9046
9047 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
9048 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
9049 an address or a port to statistics only.
9050
9051 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9052 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9053 unobvious parameters.
9054
9055 Example :
9056 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9057 backend public_www
9058 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9059 stats enable
9060 stats hide-version
9061 stats scope .
9062 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009063 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009064 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9065 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9066
9067 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9068 backend private_monitoring
9069 stats enable
9070 stats uri /admin?stats
9071 stats refresh 5s
9072
9073 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
9074
9075
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009076stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
9077 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009078 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009079 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009080
9081 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009082 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009083 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009084 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009085 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
9086
9087 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
9088 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
9089 the "stick-table" statement.
9090
9091 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
9092 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
9093 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
9094 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
9095 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
9096
9097 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
9098 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
9099 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
9100 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
9101 transformation rules.
9102
9103 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
9104 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
9105 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
9106 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
9107 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
9108 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
9109 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
9110
9111 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
9112 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
9113 ACL based conditions.
9114
9115 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
9116 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
9117 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
9118 matches can be used as fallbacks.
9119
9120 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
9121 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
9122 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
9123 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
9124
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009125 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9126 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009127 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009128
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009129 Example :
9130 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
9131 # last 30 minutes
9132 backend pop
9133 mode tcp
9134 balance roundrobin
9135 stick store-request src
9136 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
9137 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
9138 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
9139
9140 backend smtp
9141 mode tcp
9142 balance roundrobin
9143 stick match src table pop
9144 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
9145 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
9146
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009147 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009148 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009149
9150
9151stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
9152 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
9153 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9154 no | no | yes | yes
9155
9156 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
9157 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
9158 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
9159 for writing more maintainable configurations.
9160
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009161 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9162 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009163 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009164
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009165 Examples :
9166 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01009167 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009168
9169 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
9170 stick match src table pop if !localhost
9171 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
9172
9173
9174 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
9175 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
9176 backend http
9177 mode http
9178 balance roundrobin
9179 stick on src table https
9180 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
9181 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
9182 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
9183
9184 backend https
9185 mode tcp
9186 balance roundrobin
9187 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
9188 stick on src
9189 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
9190 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
9191
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009192 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009193
9194
9195stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
9196 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
9197 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9198 no | no | yes | yes
9199
9200 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009201 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009202 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009203 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009204 server is selected.
9205
9206 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
9207 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
9208 the "stick-table" statement.
9209
9210 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
9211 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
9212 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
9213 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
9214 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
9215 address.
9216
9217 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
9218 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
9219 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
9220 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
9221 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
9222 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
9223 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
9224 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
9225 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
9226 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
9227
9228 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
9229 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
9230 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
9231 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
9232 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
9233 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
9234 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
9235
9236 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
9237 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
9238 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
9239 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
9240
9241 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
9242 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
9243 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
9244 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
9245 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
9246 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01009247 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
9248 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
9249 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
9250 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
9251 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
9252 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009253
9254 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
9255 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
9256 the request.
9257
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009258 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9259 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009260 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009261
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009262 Example :
9263 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
9264 # last 30 minutes
9265 backend pop
9266 mode tcp
9267 balance roundrobin
9268 stick store-request src
9269 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
9270 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
9271 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
9272
9273 backend smtp
9274 mode tcp
9275 balance roundrobin
9276 stick match src table pop
9277 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
9278 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
9279
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009280 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009281 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009282
9283
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009284stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02009285 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
9286 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08009287 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009288 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02009289 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009290
9291 Arguments :
9292 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
9293 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
9294 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
9295 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
9296
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01009297 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
9298 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
9299 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
9300 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
9301
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009302 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
9303 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
9304 instance.
9305
9306 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
9307 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
9308 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
9309 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
9310 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
9311 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009312 to 32 characters.
9313
9314 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
9315 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
9316 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009317 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009318 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
9319 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009320
9321 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009322 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
9323 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009324 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
9325 increase.
9326
9327 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01009328 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
9329 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
9330 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009331
9332 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
9333 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
9334 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
9335 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009336 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009337 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
9338 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
9339 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
9340 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
9341 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
9342 parameter (see below).
9343
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02009344 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
9345 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
9346 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
9347 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
9348 soft restart.
9349
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +02009350 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
9351 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009352
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009353 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
9354 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
9355 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
9356 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03009357 section 2.4 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009358 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009359 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
9360 if not expiration delay is specified.
9361
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02009362 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
9363 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
9364 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
9365 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009366 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
9367 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
9368 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
9369 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
9370 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
9371 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
9372 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
9373 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
9374 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
9375 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
9376 types and their arguments.
9377
9378 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
9379 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
9380 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
9381 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
9382
9383 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
9384 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
9385 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009386 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009387
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009388 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
9389 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
9390 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009391 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009392 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009393 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009394
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009395 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
9396 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
9397 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
9398 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
9399
9400 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
9401 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
9402 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
9403 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
9404 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
9405 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
9406
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009407 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
9408 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
9409 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
9410 they were received.
9411
9412 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9413 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
9414 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
9415 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
9416 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
9417
9418 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9419 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9420 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9421 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
9422 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9423
9424 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
9425 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
9426 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
9427
9428 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9429 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9430 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9431 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
9432 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9433
9434 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9435 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
9436 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
9437 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
9438 the client side.
9439
9440 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9441 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9442 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9443 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
9444 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
9445 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
9446 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
9447
9448 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9449 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
9450 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
9451 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
9452 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
9453 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009454 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009455
9456 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9457 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9458 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9459 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
9460 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
9461 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9462
9463 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009464 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009465 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
9466 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
9467
9468 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9469 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9470 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9471 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
9472 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
9473 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
9474 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
9475 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
9476 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
9477 recommended for better fairness.
9478
9479 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009480 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009481 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
9482 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
9483
9484 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
9485 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9486 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9487 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
9488 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
9489 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
9490 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
9491 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
9492 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
9493 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02009494
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02009495 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
9496 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009497 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
9498 reference it.
9499
9500 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
9501 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +01009502 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
9503 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
9504 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009505
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009506 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
9507 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
9508 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
9509 something that can be ignored.
9510
9511 Example:
9512 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
9513 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
9514 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
9515 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
9516
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03009517 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.4
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01009518 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009519
9520
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009521stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +01009522 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009523 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9524 no | no | yes | yes
9525
9526 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009527 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009528 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009529 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009530 server is selected.
9531
9532 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
9533 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
9534 the "stick-table" statement.
9535
9536 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
9537 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
9538 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
9539 when the response is a SSL server hello.
9540
9541 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
9542 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
9543 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
9544 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
9545 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
9546 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009547 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009548 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
9549 rules.
9550
9551 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
9552 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
9553 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
9554 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
9555 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
9556 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
9557 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
9558
9559 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
9560 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
9561 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
9562 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
9563
9564 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
9565 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
9566 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
9567 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
9568 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
9569 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01009570 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
9571 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
9572 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
9573 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
9574 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
9575 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
9576 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
9577 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
9578 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009579
9580 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
9581
9582 Example :
9583 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
9584 backend https
9585 mode tcp
9586 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009587 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009588 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009589
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009590 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
9591 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
9592
9593 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
9594 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
9595 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
9596
9597 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
9598 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009599
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009600 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
9601 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
9602 # at offset 44.
9603
9604 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
9605 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
9606
9607 # Learn on response if server hello.
9608 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009609
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009610 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
9611 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
9612
9613 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
9614 extraction.
9615
9616
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009617tcp-check connect [params*]
9618 Opens a new connection
9619 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9620 no | no | yes | yes
9621
9622 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
9623 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
9624 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
9625
9626 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
9627 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
9628 of the sequence.
9629
9630 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
9631 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
9632 do.
9633
9634 Parameters :
9635 They are optional and can be used to describe how HAProxy should open and
9636 use the TCP connection.
9637
9638 port if not set, check port or server port is used.
9639 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
9640 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to 65535.
9641
9642 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
9643
9644 ssl opens a ciphered connection
9645
9646 Examples:
9647 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
9648 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
9649 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
9650 option tcp-check
9651 tcp-check connect
9652 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
9653 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
9654 tcp-check send \r\n
9655 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
9656 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
9657 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
9658 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
9659 tcp-check send \r\n
9660 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
9661 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
9662
9663 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
9664 option tcp-check
9665 tcp-check connect port 110
9666 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
9667 tcp-check connect port 143
9668 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
9669 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
9670
9671 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
9672
9673
9674tcp-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009675 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009676 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9677 no | no | yes | yes
9678
9679 Arguments :
9680 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
9681 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring" or
9682 binary.
9683 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
9684 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
9685 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
9686
9687 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
9688 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
9689 with the usual backslash ('\').
9690 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009691 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009692 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
9693 used upper or lower case.
9694
9695
9696 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
9697
9698 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
9699 A health check response will be considered valid if the
9700 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
9701 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
9702 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
9703 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
9704 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
9705 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
9706
9707 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
9708 A health check response will be considered valid if the
9709 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
9710 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
9711 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
9712 expression.
9713
9714 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
9715 in the response buffer. A health check response will
9716 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
9717 this exact hexadecimal string.
9718 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
9719
9720 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
9721 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
9722 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
9723 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
9724 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
9725 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
9726 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
9727 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
9728 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
9729 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
9730 the null character.
9731
9732 Examples :
9733 # perform a POP check
9734 option tcp-check
9735 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
9736
9737 # perform an IMAP check
9738 option tcp-check
9739 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
9740
9741 # look for the redis master server
9742 option tcp-check
9743 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02009744 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009745 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9746 tcp-check expect string role:master
9747 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
9748 tcp-check expect string +OK
9749
9750
9751 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
9752 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
9753
9754
9755tcp-check send <data>
9756 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9757 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9758 no | no | yes | yes
9759
9760 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9761 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
9762
9763 Examples :
9764 # look for the redis master server
9765 option tcp-check
9766 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9767 tcp-check expect string role:master
9768
9769 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
9770 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
9771
9772
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009773tcp-check send-binary <hexstring>
9774 Specify a hex digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009775 tcp health check
9776 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9777 no | no | yes | yes
9778
9779 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9780 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009781 <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009782 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
9783 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact
9784 hexadecimal string.
9785 Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary protocols.
9786
9787 Examples :
9788 # redis check in binary
9789 option tcp-check
9790 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
9791 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
9792
9793
9794 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
9795 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
9796
9797
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009798tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9799 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02009800 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9801 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009802 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009803 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9804 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02009805
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009806 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009807
9808 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
9809 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009810 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
9811 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
9812 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
9813 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
9814 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
9815 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009816
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009817 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
9818 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
9819 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
9820 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009821
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02009822 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009823 - accept :
9824 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9825 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9826 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009827
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009828 - reject :
9829 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9830 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9831 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
9832 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
9833 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
9834 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
9835 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
9836 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
9837 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
9838 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
9839 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009840 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009841
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02009842 - expect-proxy layer4 :
9843 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
9844 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
9845 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
9846 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
9847 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
9848 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
9849 hosts.
9850
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +01009851 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
9852 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
9853 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
9854 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
9855 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
9856 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
9857 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
9858 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
9859
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009860 - capture <sample> len <length> :
9861 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
9862 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
9863 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
9864 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
9865 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
9866 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
9867 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
9868 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02009869 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
9870 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009871
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009872 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009873 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +02009874 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The
9875 number of counters that may be simultaneously tracked by the same
9876 connection is set in MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -05009877 haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3, so the track-sc number is between 0
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +02009878 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first "track-sc0" rule executed enables
9879 tracking of the counters of the specified table as the first set. The
9880 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
9881 specified table as the second set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
9882 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the third
9883 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
9884 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
9885 But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009886
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009887 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009888 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009889 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009890 request or connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined,
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009891 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
9892 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
9893 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009894
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009895 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
9896 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
9897 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
9898 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009899
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009900 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
9901 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
9902 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
9903 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
9904 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009905 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
9906 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
9907 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
9908 layer7 information is extracted.
9909
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009910 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
9911 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
9912 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
9913 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
9914 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009915
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009916 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
9917 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
9918 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
9919 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
9920
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009921 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
9922 The "sc-inc-gpc1" increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
9923 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
9924 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
9925
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009926 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>:
9927 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
9928 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
9929 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
9930 continues.
9931
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009932 - set-src <expr> :
9933 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
9934 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
9935 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02009936 set-src".
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009937
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02009938 Arguments:
9939 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9940 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009941
9942 Example:
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009943 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
9944
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009945 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
9946 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009947
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009948 - set-src-port <expr> :
9949 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
9950 expression.
9951
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02009952 Arguments:
9953 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9954 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009955
9956 Example:
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009957 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
9958
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009959 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
9960 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
9961 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009962
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02009963 - set-dst <expr> :
9964 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
9965 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
9966 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
9967 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
9968 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
9969
9970 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9971 followed by some converters.
9972
9973 Example:
9974
9975 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
9976 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
9977
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009978 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
9979 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
9980
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02009981 - set-dst-port <expr> :
9982 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
9983 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
9984 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
9985
9986
9987 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9988 followed by some converters.
9989
9990 Example:
9991
9992 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
9993
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009994 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
9995 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
9996 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
9997
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009998 - "silent-drop" :
9999 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010000 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010001 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
10002 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
10003 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
10004 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
10005 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010006 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
10007 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010008 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
10009 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010010 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010011 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
10012 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
10013 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
10014 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
10015
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010016 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
10017 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10018 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010019
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010020 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
10021 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
10022 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010023
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010024 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010025 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010026 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010027
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010028 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
10029 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
10030 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010031
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010032 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010033 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
10034 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010035
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020010036 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
10037
10038 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
10039
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010040 See section 7 about ACL usage.
10041
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010042 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010043
10044
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010045tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10046 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010047 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020010048 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010049 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020010050 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10051 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010052
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010053 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010054
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010055 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010056 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
10057 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
10058 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
10059 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010060
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010061 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
10062 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
10063 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
10064 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010010065 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
10066 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
10067 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
10068 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
10069 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
10070 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010071 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010010072 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010073
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010074 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
10075 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
10076 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
10077 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010078
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010079 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020010080 - accept : the request is accepted
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010010081 - do-resolve: perform a DNS resolution
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020010082 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
10083 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040010084 - set-priority-class <expr> | set-priority-offset <expr>
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010085 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020010086 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010087 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Thierry Fournierb9125672016-03-29 19:34:37 +020010088 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020010089 - set-dst <expr>
10090 - set-dst-port <expr>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010091 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010092 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010093 - silent-drop
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010094 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010095
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010096 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
10097 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010010098 For "do-resolve" action, please check the "http-request do-resolve"
10099 configuration section.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010100
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010010101 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
10102 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
10103 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
10104 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
10105 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
10106 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010107
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010108 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010109 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10110 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010111
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010112 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020010113 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
10114 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
10115 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
10116 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010010117 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
10118 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
10119 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010120
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010121 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020010122 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
10123 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
10124 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010125
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020010126 The "set-dst" and "set-dst-port" are used to set respectively the destination
10127 IP and port. More information on how to use it at "http-request set-dst".
10128
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010129 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010130 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
10131 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010132
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010133 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
10134 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010010135 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010136 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
10137 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010138 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010139 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010140 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010141 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
10142 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010143 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010010144 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
10145 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010146
10147 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10148 followed by some converters.
10149
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010150 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
10151 <var-name>.
10152
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040010153 The "set-priority-class" is used to set the queue priority class of the
10154 current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an
10155 integer in the range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be
10156 truncated. The priority class determines the order in which queued requests
10157 are processed. Lower values have higher priority.
10158
10159 The "set-priority-offset" is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset
10160 of the current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts
10161 to an integer in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be
10162 truncated. When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority
10163 class, then by the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in
10164 milliseconds. Lower values have higher priority.
10165 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision for
10166 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
10167 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
10168 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
10169 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
10170
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020010171 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
10172 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
10173 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
10174 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
10175 the SPOE agent name must be used.
10176
10177 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
10178
10179 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
10180
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010181 Example:
10182
10183 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010184 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010185
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010186 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010187 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
10188 # and reject everything else.
10189 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
10190 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020010191 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010192 tcp-request content reject
10193
10194 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010195 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
10196 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
10197 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010198 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010199
10200 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
10201 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
10202 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010203 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010204 tcp-request content reject
10205
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010206 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010207 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010208 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020010209 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010210 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
10211 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010212
10213 Example:
10214 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
10215 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020010216 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010217
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010218 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010219 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010220
10221 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010222 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010223 # protecting all our sites
10224 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010225 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
10226 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010227 ...
10228 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
10229
10230 backend http_dynamic
10231 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010232 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010233 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010234 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010235 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010236 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010237 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010238
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010239 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010240
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +030010241 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
10242 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010243
10244
10245tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
10246 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
10247 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020010248 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010249 Arguments :
10250 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10251 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10252 as explained at the top of this document.
10253
10254 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
10255 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
10256 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
10257 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
10258 data for at most the specified amount of time.
10259
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020010260 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
10261 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
10262 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
10263 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
10264
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010265 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
10266 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010267 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010268 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +010010269 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
10270 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
10271 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
10272 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010273
10274 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
10275 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
10276 it pass through unaffected.
10277
10278 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
10279 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
10280 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010281 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010282 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
10283 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +020010284 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
10285 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
10286 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010287
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010288 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010289 "timeout client".
10290
10291
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010292tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10293 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
10294 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10295 no | no | yes | yes
10296 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020010297 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10298 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010299
10300 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
10301
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010302 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010303 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
10304 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020010305 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
10306 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010307
10308 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
10309
10310 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
10311 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
10312 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
10313 inserted.
10314
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010315 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010316 - accept :
10317 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
10318 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
10319 the rules evaluation.
10320
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020010321 - close :
10322 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
10323 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
10324 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
10325 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
10326 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
10327 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010328 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020010329 protocols.
10330
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010331 - reject :
10332 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
10333 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010334 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010335
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010336 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
10337 Sets a variable.
10338
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010339 - unset-var(<var-name>)
10340 Unsets a variable.
10341
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020010342 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
10343 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
10344 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
10345 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
10346
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010347 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
10348 This action increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
10349 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
10350 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
10351
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010352 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
10353 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
10354 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
10355 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
10356 continues.
10357
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010358 - "silent-drop" :
10359 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010360 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010361 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
10362 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
10363 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
10364 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
10365 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010366 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
10367 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010368 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
10369 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010370 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010371 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
10372 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
10373 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
10374 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
10375
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020010376 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
10377 Send a group of SPOE messages.
10378
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010379 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
10380 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10381 for changing the default action to a reject.
10382
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010383 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
10384 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
10385 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
10386 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010387 period.
10388
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010389 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
10390 declared inline.
10391
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010392 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
10393 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010010394 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010395 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
10396 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010397 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010398 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010399 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010400 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
10401 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010402 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010010403 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
10404 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010405
10406 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10407 followed by some converters.
10408
10409 Example:
10410
10411 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
10412
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010413 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
10414 <var-name>.
10415
10416 Example:
10417
10418 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var)
10419
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020010420 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
10421 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
10422 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
10423 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
10424 the SPOE agent name must be used.
10425
10426 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
10427
10428 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
10429
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010430 See section 7 about ACL usage.
10431
10432 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
10433
10434
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010435tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10436 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
10437 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10438 no | yes | yes | no
10439 Arguments :
10440 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10441 below.
10442
10443 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
10444
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010445 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010446 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
10447 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
10448 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
10449 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
10450 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
10451 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
10452 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010453 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010454 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
10455 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
10456 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
10457 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
10458 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
10459 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
10460 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
10461 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
10462 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
10463 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
10464 instead.
10465
10466 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
10467 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
10468 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
10469 rules which may be inserted.
10470
10471 Several types of actions are supported :
10472 - accept : the request is accepted
10473 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
10474 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
10475 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010476 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010477 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>
10478 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010479 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010480 - silent-drop
10481
10482 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
10483 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
10484 sections for a complete description.
10485
10486 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
10487 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10488 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
10489
10490 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
10491 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
10492 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
10493 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
10494 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
10495
10496 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
10497 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10498
10499 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
10500 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
10501 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
10502
10503 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
10504 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
10505 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10506
10507 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
10508 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
10509 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
10510
10511 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
10512 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10513 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
10514
10515 See section 7 about ACL usage.
10516
10517 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
10518
10519
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010520tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
10521 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
10522 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10523 no | no | yes | yes
10524 Arguments :
10525 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10526 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10527 as explained at the top of this document.
10528
10529 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
10530
10531
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010532timeout check <timeout>
10533 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
10534 established.
10535
10536 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10537 yes | no | yes | yes
10538 Arguments:
10539 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10540 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10541 as explained at the top of this document.
10542
10543 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
10544 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010545 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010546 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +010010547 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
10548 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
10549 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010550
10551 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
10552 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
10553
10554 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
10555 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010556 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010557
10558 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10559 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10560 forget about it.
10561
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010562 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
10563 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010564
10565
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010566timeout client <timeout>
10567timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
10568 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
10569 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10570 yes | yes | yes | no
10571 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010572 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010573 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10574 as explained at the top of this document.
10575
10576 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
10577 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
10578 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010010579 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
10580 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
10581 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
10582 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010583 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
10584 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
10585 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010586 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010587 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010588 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
10589 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010590 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
10591 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010592
10593 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
10594 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10595 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10596 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010597 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010598 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10599
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010600 This also applies to HTTP/2 connections, which will be closed with GOAWAY.
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010010601
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010602 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
10603 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
10604 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
10605
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010010606 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server", "timeout tunnel",
10607 "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010608
10609
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010610timeout client-fin <timeout>
10611 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
10612 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10613 yes | yes | yes | no
10614 Arguments :
10615 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10616 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10617 as explained at the top of this document.
10618
10619 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
10620 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
10621 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
10622 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
10623 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
10624 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
10625 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +010010626 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
10627 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
10628 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010629
10630 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
10631 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
10632 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
10633
10634 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
10635
10636
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010637timeout connect <timeout>
10638timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
10639 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
10640 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10641 yes | no | yes | yes
10642 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010643 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010644 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10645 as explained at the top of this document.
10646
10647 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010648 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010649 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010650 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010651 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
10652 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010653
10654 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10655 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10656 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10657 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010658 during startup because it may result in accumulation of failed sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010659 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10660
10661 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
10662 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
10663 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
10664
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010665 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
10666 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010667
10668
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010669timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
10670 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
10671 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10672 yes | yes | yes | yes
10673 Arguments :
10674 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10675 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10676 as explained at the top of this document.
10677
10678 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
10679 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
10680 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
10681 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
10682 once the request has started to present itself.
10683
10684 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
10685 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
10686 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
10687 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
10688 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
10689
10690 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
10691 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
10692 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
10693 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
10694
10695 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
10696 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010697 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010698 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
10699 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020010700 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010701
10702 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
10703 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
10704 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
10705 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
10706
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010707 When using HTTP/2 "timeout client" is applied instead. This is so we can keep
10708 using short keep-alive timeouts in HTTP/1.1 while using longer ones in HTTP/2
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010010709 (where we only have one connection per client and a connection setup).
10710
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010711 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
10712
10713
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010714timeout http-request <timeout>
10715 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
10716 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020010717 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010718 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010719 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010720 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10721 as explained at the top of this document.
10722
10723 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
10724 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
10725 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
10726 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
10727 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
10728 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
10729 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020010730 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
10731 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
10732 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
10733 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010734 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020010735 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
10736 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010737
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010010738 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
10739 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
10740 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
10741 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
10742 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010743 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010744
10745 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
10746 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010747 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010748 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
10749 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
10750
10751 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020010752 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
10753 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
10754 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010755
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020010756 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010010757 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010758
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010759
10760timeout queue <timeout>
10761 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
10762 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10763 yes | no | yes | yes
10764 Arguments :
10765 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10766 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10767 as explained at the top of this document.
10768
10769 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
10770 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
10771 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
10772 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
10773 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
10774
10775 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
10776 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
10777 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
10778 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
10779
10780 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
10781
10782
10783timeout server <timeout>
10784timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
10785 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
10786 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10787 yes | no | yes | yes
10788 Arguments :
10789 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10790 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10791 as explained at the top of this document.
10792
10793 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
10794 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
10795 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
10796 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
10797 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
10798 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
10799 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
10800
10801 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10802 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10803 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
10804 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
10805 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010806 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010807 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010808 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
10809 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010810 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
10811 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010812
10813 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10814 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10815 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10816 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010817 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010818 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10819
10820 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
10821 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
10822 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
10823
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010824 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010825
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010826
10827timeout server-fin <timeout>
10828 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
10829 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10830 yes | no | yes | yes
10831 Arguments :
10832 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10833 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10834 as explained at the top of this document.
10835
10836 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
10837 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
10838 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
10839 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
10840 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
10841 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
10842 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
10843 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
10844 situations, it should not be needed.
10845
10846 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10847 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
10848 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
10849
10850 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
10851
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010852
10853timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010010854 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010855 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10856 yes | yes | yes | yes
10857 Arguments :
10858 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
10859 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10860 as explained at the top of this document.
10861
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010862 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit" or
10863 "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with no activity for a certain
10864 amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit" defines how long it will
10865 be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010866
10867 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10868 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10869 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
10870 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010010871 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010872
10873 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
10874
10875
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010876timeout tunnel <timeout>
10877 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
10878 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10879 yes | no | yes | yes
10880 Arguments :
10881 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10882 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10883 as explained at the top of this document.
10884
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010885 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010886 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
10887 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
10888 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010889 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
10890 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010891 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
10892 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
10893 specified.
10894
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010895 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
10896 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
10897 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
10898 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
10899 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
10900 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
10901 state.
10902
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010903 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10904 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10905 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
10906 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010907 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010908
10909 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10910 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10911 forget about it.
10912
10913 Example :
10914 defaults http
10915 option http-server-close
10916 timeout connect 5s
10917 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010918 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010919 timeout server 30s
10920 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
10921
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010922 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010923
10924
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010925transparent (deprecated)
10926 Enable client-side transparent proxying
10927 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010010928 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010929 Arguments : none
10930
10931 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
10932 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
10933 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
10934 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
10935 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
10936 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
10937 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
10938 appropriate server.
10939
10940 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
10941
10942 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
10943 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
10944
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010945 See also: "option transparent"
10946
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010947unique-id-format <string>
10948 Generate a unique ID for each request.
10949 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10950 yes | yes | yes | no
10951 Arguments :
10952 <string> is a log-format string.
10953
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010954 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
10955 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
10956 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
10957 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010958
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010959 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
10960 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
10961 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
10962 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
10963 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
10964 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
10965 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
10966 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010967
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010968 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
10969 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010970
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010971 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010972
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050010973 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010974
10975 will generate:
10976
10977 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
10978
10979 See also: "unique-id-header"
10980
10981unique-id-header <name>
10982 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
10983 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10984 yes | yes | yes | no
10985 Arguments :
10986 <name> is the name of the header.
10987
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010988 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
10989 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010990
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010991 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010992
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050010993 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010994 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
10995
10996 will generate:
10997
10998 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
10999
11000 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011001
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020011002use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020011003 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011004 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11005 no | yes | yes | no
11006 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010011007 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
11008 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011009
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020011010 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
11011 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011012
11013 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
11014 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
11015 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020011016 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011017 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020011018 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
11019 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011020
11021 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
11022 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
11023 assign the backend.
11024
11025 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
11026 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
11027 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
11028 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
11029 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
11030 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
11031
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020011032 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011033 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020011034 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
11035 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
11036 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
11037
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010011038 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
11039 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
11040 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
11041 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
11042 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
11043 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
11044 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
11045 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
11046 cannot be forced from the request.
11047
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011048 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010011049 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
11050 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
11051
11052 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
11053 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011054
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011055
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011056use-server <server> if <condition>
11057use-server <server> unless <condition>
11058 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
11059 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11060 no | no | yes | yes
11061 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011062 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011063
11064 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
11065
11066 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
11067 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
11068 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
11069
11070 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
11071 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
11072 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
11073 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
11074 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
11075 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
11076 matches will assign the server.
11077
11078 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
11079 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
11080 with the next rules until one matches.
11081
11082 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
11083 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
11084 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
11085 according to other persistence mechanisms.
11086
11087 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
11088 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
11089 stripped.
11090
11091 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
11092 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
11093 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
11094 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
11095
11096 Example :
11097 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
11098 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
11099 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
11100 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
11101 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
11102 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000011103 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011104 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
11105 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
11106
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011107 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011108
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011109
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100111105. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011111--------------------------
11112
11113The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
11114depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
11115settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
11116written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
11117described in this section.
11118
11119
111205.1. Bind options
11121-----------------
11122
11123The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
11124as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
11125no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
11126parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
11127while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
11128provided immediately after the setting name.
11129
11130The currently supported settings are the following ones.
11131
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010011132accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
11133 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
11134 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
11135 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
11136 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
11137 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
11138 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
11139 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
11140 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
11141 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010011142 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
11143 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
11144 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010011145
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011146accept-proxy
11147 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020011148 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
11149 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011150 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
11151 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
11152 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
11153 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011154 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011155 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
11156 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020011157 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
11158 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011159
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020011160allow-0rtt
Bertrand Jacquina25282b2018-08-14 00:56:13 +010011161 Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010011162 due to security considerations. Because it is vulnerable to replay attacks,
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011163 you should only allow if for requests that are safe to replay, i.e. requests
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010011164 that are idempotent. You can use the "wait-for-handshake" action for any
11165 request that wouldn't be safe with early data.
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020011166
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011167alpn <protocols>
11168 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
11169 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
11170 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011171 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011172 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010011173 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to enable HTTP/2 on an HTTP frontend.
11174 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
11175 now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most browsers still
11176 support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may still work for
11177 a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1
11178 are expected to be supported, both versions can be advertised, in order of
11179 preference, like below :
11180
11181 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011182
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011183backlog <backlog>
Willy Tarreaue2711c72019-02-27 15:39:41 +010011184 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified or 0, the frontend's
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011185 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
11186
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010011187curves <curves>
11188 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
11189 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
11190 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
11191 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
11192 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
11193 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
11194
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020011195ecdhe <named curve>
11196 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010011197 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
11198 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020011199
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020011200ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020011201 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11202 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
11203 client's certificate.
11204
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020011205ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
11206 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
11207 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
11208 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
11209 error is ignored.
11210
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011211ca-sign-file <cafile>
11212 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11213 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
11214 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
11215 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
11216 'generate-certificates' for details.
11217
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000011218ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011219 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
11220 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
11221 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
11222 'generate-certificates' for details.
11223
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011224ciphers <ciphers>
11225 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
11226 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +000011227 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000011228 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020011229 information and recommendations see e.g.
11230 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
11231 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
11232 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
11233
11234ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
11235 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
11236 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the string describing
11237 the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated during the
11238 TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000011239 OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section. For cipher configuration
11240 for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers" keyword.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011241
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020011242crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020011243 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11244 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
11245 to verify client's certificate.
11246
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011247crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011248 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11249 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
11250 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
11251 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
11252 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
11253 file.
11254
11255 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
11256 are loaded.
11257
11258 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010011259 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends with
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010011260 '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This directive may be
11261 specified multiple times in order to load certificates from multiple files or
11262 directories. The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a
11263 valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their CN or alt
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011264 subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used
11265 instead of the first hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010011266 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011267
11268 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
11269 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
11270 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
11271 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010011272 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
11273 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011274
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020011275 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011276
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011277 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011278 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011279 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
11280 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011281 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
11282 clients).
11283
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020011284 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
11285 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
11286 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
11287 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
11288 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
11289 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
11290 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
11291 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
11292 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
11293 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
11294 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
11295 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
11296 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
11297
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010011298 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
11299 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
11300 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
11301 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
11302 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
11303
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011304 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
11305 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
11306 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
11307 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011308
11309 In order to provide this functionality, multiple PEM files, each with a
11310 different key type, are required. To associate these PEM files into a
11311 "cert bundle" that is recognized by haproxy, they must be named in the
11312 following way: All PEM files that are to be bundled must have the same base
11313 name, with a suffix indicating the key type. Currently, three suffixes are
11314 supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For example, if www.example.com has two PEM
11315 files, an RSA file and an ECDSA file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa"
11316 and "example.pem.ecdsa". The first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the
11317 suffix matters. To load this bundle into haproxy, specify the base name only:
11318
11319 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
11320
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011321 Note that the suffix is not given to haproxy; this tells haproxy to look for
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011322 a cert bundle.
11323
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011324 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle at the same time to try to
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011325 support multiple key types. PEM files are combined based on Common Name
11326 (CN) and Subject Alternative Name (SAN) to support SNI lookups. This means
11327 that even if you give haproxy a cert bundle, if there are no shared CN/SAN
11328 entries in the certificates in that bundle, haproxy will not be able to
11329 provide multi-cert support.
11330
11331 Assuming bundle in the example above contained the following:
11332
11333 Filename | CN | SAN
11334 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
11335 example.pem.rsa | www.example.com | rsa.example.com
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011336 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011337 example.pem.ecdsa | www.example.com | ecdsa.example.com
11338 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
11339
11340 Users connecting with an SNI of "www.example.com" will be able
11341 to use both RSA and ECDSA cipher suites. Users connecting with an SNI of
11342 "rsa.example.com" will only be able to use RSA cipher suites, and users
11343 connecting with "ecdsa.example.com" will only be able to use ECDSA cipher
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020011344 suites. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is natively supported,
11345 no need to bundle certificates. ECDSA certificate will be preferred if client
11346 support it.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011347
11348 If a directory name is given as the <cert> argument, haproxy will
11349 automatically search and load bundled files in that directory.
11350
11351 OSCP files (.ocsp) and issuer files (.issuer) are supported with multi-cert
11352 bundling. Each certificate can have its own .ocsp and .issuer file. At this
11353 time, sctl is not supported in multi-certificate bundling.
11354
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020011355crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011356 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011357 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011358 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011359 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020011360
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011361crt-list <file>
11362 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011363 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
11364 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011365
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011366 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
11367
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020011368 sslbindconf support "npn", "alpn", "verify", "ca-file", "no-ca-names",
11369 crl-file", "ecdhe", "curves", "ciphers" configuration. With BoringSSL
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020011370 and Openssl >= 1.1.1 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also supported.
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011371 It override the configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011372
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020011373 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
11374 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
11375 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
11376 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
11377 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
11378 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
11379 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
11380 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011381
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011382 Multi-cert bundling (see "crt") is supported with crt-list, as long as only
Emmanuel Hocdetd294aea2016-05-13 11:14:06 +020011383 the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do the same work on
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020011384 all bundled certificates. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is
11385 natively supported, avoid multi-cert bundling. RSA and ECDSA certificates can
11386 be declared in a row, and set different ssl and filter parameter.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011387
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011388 crt-list file example:
11389 cert1.pem
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010011390 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011391 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010011392 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011393
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011394defer-accept
11395 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
11396 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
11397 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011398 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011399 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
11400 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
11401 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
11402 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
11403 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
11404 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
11405 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
11406
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020011407expose-fd listeners
11408 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
11409 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +020011410 During a reload with the master-worker mode, the process is automatically
11411 reexecuted adding -x and one of the stats socket with this option.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011412 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020011413
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011414force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011415 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011416 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011417 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011418 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011419
11420force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011421 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011422 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011423 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011424
11425force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011426 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011427 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011428 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011429
11430force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011431 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011432 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011433 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011434
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011435force-tlsv13
11436 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
11437 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011438 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011439
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011440generate-certificates
11441 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11442 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
11443 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
11444 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
11445 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
11446 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
11447 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
11448 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
11449 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
11450 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
11451 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
11452
11453 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
11454 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011455 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011456 certificate is used many times.
11457
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011458gid <gid>
11459 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
11460 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11461 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
11462 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
11463 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11464
11465group <group>
11466 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
11467 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
11468 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
11469 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
11470 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11471
11472id <id>
11473 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
11474 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
11475 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
11476 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
11477
11478interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010011479 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
11480 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
11481 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
11482 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
11483 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
11484 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010011485 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
11486 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
11487 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
11488 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
11489 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
11490 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011491
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011492level <level>
11493 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
11494 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
11495 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011496 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011497 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
11498 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
11499 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011500 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011501 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011502 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011503 all counters).
11504
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020011505severity-output <format>
11506 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
11507 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
11508 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
11509 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
11510 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
11511 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
11512 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
11513 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
11514 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
11515 rfc5424 convention.
11516
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011517maxconn <maxconn>
11518 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
11519 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
11520 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
11521 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
11522 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
11523 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
11524 eat all memory.
11525
11526mode <mode>
11527 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
11528 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
11529 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
11530 UNIX sockets.
11531
11532mss <maxseg>
11533 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
11534 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
11535 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
11536 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
11537 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
11538 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
11539 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
11540 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
11541 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
11542 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
11543 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
11544
11545name <name>
11546 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
11547 page.
11548
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020011549namespace <name>
11550 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
11551 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
11552 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
11553 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
11554
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011555nice <nice>
11556 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
11557 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
11558 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
11559 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
11560 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
11561 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
11562 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
11563 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
11564 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
11565 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
11566 one for an RDP socket.
11567
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020011568no-ca-names
11569 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11570 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
11571
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011572no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011573 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011574 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011575 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011576 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011577 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
11578 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011579
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020011580no-tls-tickets
11581 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11582 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
11583 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011584 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
11585 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020011586
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011587no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011588 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011589 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011590 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011591 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011592 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11593 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011594
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011595no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011596 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011597 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011598 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011599 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011600 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11601 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011602
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011603no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011604 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011605 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011606 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011607 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011608 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11609 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011610
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011611no-tlsv13
11612 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11613 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
11614 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
11615 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011616 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11617 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011618
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020011619npn <protocols>
11620 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
11621 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
11622 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011623 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011624 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010011625 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
11626 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
11627 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
11628 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
11629 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020011630
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000011631prefer-client-ciphers
11632 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
11633 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
11634 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribus926594f2018-05-18 17:55:57 +020011635 Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
11636 (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
11637 the client cipher list.
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000011638
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011639process <process-set>[/<thread-set>]
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010011640 This restricts the list of processes or threads on which this listener is
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011641 allowed to run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011642 not match. If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011643 between the two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run
11644 on any remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either
11645 run on the first process of the listener if a single process was specified,
11646 or on all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. If a thread
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011647 set is specified, it limits the threads allowed to process incoming
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010011648 connections for this listener, for the the process set. If multiple processes
11649 and threads are configured, a warning is emitted, as it either results from a
11650 configuration error or a misunderstanding of these models. For the unlikely
11651 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated.
11652 <process-set> and <thread-set> must use the format
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011653
11654 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
11655
11656 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
11657 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose of
11658 this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have one different
11659 socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind lines sharing
11660 the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so that the system
11661 can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues and allow a
11662 smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known
11663 for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020011664
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020011665proto <name>
11666 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
11667 must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
11668 be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
11669 in haproxy -vv.
11670 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
11671 protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
Joseph Herlant71b4b152018-11-13 16:55:16 -080011672 instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifying "proto
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020011673 h2" on the bind line.
11674
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011675ssl
11676 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011677 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011678 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
11679 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020011680 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
11681 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011682
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011683ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
11684 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
11685 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
11686 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
11687
11688ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
11689 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections instantiated
11690 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
11691 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
11692
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010011693strict-sni
11694 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
11695 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
11696 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
11697 See the "crt" option for more information.
11698
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011699tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010011700 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011701 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
11702 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011703 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011704 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
11705 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
11706 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
11707 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
11708 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
11709 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
11710 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
11711
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011712tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010011713 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011714 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
11715 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
11716 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
11717 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
11718 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
11719 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
11720 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020011721 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
11722 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
11723 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011724
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010011725tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
11726 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
Emeric Brun9e754772019-01-10 17:51:55 +010011727 or 80 bytes long, depending if aes128 or aes256 is used, encoded with base64
11728 with one line per key (ex. openssl rand 80 | openssl base64 -A | xargs echo).
11729 The first key determines the key length used for next keys: you can't mix
11730 aes128 and aes256 keys. Number of keys is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO
11731 build option (default 3) and at least as many keys need to be present in
11732 the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be used for decryption and the
11733 penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy key rotation by just
11734 appending new key to the file and reloading the process. Keys must be
11735 periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy is
11736 compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010011737 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
11738 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
11739
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011740transparent
11741 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
11742 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
11743 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
11744 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
11745 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
11746 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
11747 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
11748 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
11749 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
11750 so check for support with your vendor.
11751
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011752v4v6
11753 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
11754 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
11755 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
11756 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011757 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011758
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010011759v6only
11760 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
11761 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
11762 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011763 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
11764 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010011765
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011766uid <uid>
11767 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
11768 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11769 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
11770 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
11771 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11772
11773user <user>
11774 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
11775 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11776 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
11777 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
11778 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11779
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020011780verify [none|optional|required]
11781 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
11782 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
11783 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
11784 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
11785 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020011786 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
11787 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
11788 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
11789 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011790
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200117915.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010011792------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011793
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010011794The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
11795which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
11796arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
11797settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
11798after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
11799Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
11800address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011801
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011802 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010011803 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011804
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011805Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
11806keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
11807
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011808The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011809
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020011810addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011811 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010011812 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
11813 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
11814 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
11815 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
11816 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011817
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011818agent-check
11819 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011820 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
Willy Tarreau7a0139e2018-12-16 08:42:56 +010011821 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string
11822 terminated by the first '\r' or '\n' met. The string is made of a series of
11823 words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas in any order, each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011824
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011825 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011826 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020011827 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
11828 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
11829 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011830
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011831 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
11832 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
11833 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
11834 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
11835 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020011836
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011837 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011838 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011839
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011840 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
11841 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
11842 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011843
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011844 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
11845 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
11846 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011847
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011848 - The words "down", "failed", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
11849 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
11850 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
11851 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
11852 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011853 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011854 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011855
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011856 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
11857 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011858
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011859 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
11860 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
11861 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
11862 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
11863 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
11864 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
11865 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
11866 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
11867 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011868
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090011869 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
11870 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011871 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
11872 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
11873 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010011874 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090011875
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011876 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011877 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011878
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070011879agent-send <string>
11880 If this option is specified, haproxy will send the given string (verbatim)
11881 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
11882 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
11883 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
11884 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
11885
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011886agent-inter <delay>
11887 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
11888 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
11889
11890 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
11891 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
11892 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
11893 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
11894 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
11895 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
11896 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
11897 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
11898 of backends use the same servers.
11899
11900 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
11901
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010011902agent-addr <addr>
11903 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
11904
11905 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
11906 managing status and weights of servers defined in haproxy in case you can't
11907 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
11908 hostname, it will be resolved.
11909
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011910agent-port <port>
11911 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
11912
11913 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
11914
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020011915allow-0rtt
11916 Allow sending early data to the server when using TLS 1.3.
Olivier Houchard22c9b442019-05-06 19:01:04 +020011917 Note that early data will be sent only if the client used early data, or
11918 if the backend uses "retry-on" with the "0rtt-rejected" keyword.
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020011919
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010011920alpn <protocols>
11921 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
11922 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
11923 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011924 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010011925 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
11926 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to connect to HTTP/2 servers.
11927 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
11928 now obsolete NPN extension.
11929 If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1 are expected to be supported, both versions can
11930 be advertised, in order of preference, like below :
11931
11932 server 127.0.0.1:443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
11933
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011934backup
11935 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
11936 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
11937 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
11938 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011939 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
11940 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011941
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011942ca-file <cafile>
11943 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11944 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
11945 server's certificate.
11946
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011947check
11948 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +010011949 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
11950 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
11951 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
11952 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
11953 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
11954 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
11955 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +090011956 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
11957 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011958 refer to those options and parameters for more information. See also
11959 "no-check" option.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011960
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020011961check-send-proxy
11962 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
11963 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
11964 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
11965 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
11966 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
11967 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
11968 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
11969
Olivier Houchard92150142018-12-21 19:47:01 +010011970check-alpn <protocols>
11971 Defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol list consists in
11972 a comma-delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0"
11973 (without quotes). If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
11974
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010011975check-sni <sni>
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020011976 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010011977 over SSL. It is only possible to use a string to set <sni>. If you want to
11978 set a SNI for proxied traffic, see "sni".
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020011979
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011980check-ssl
11981 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
11982 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
11983 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
11984 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011985 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011986 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
11987 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011988 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011989 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
11990 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011991
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080011992check-via-socks4
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011993 This option enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy. By
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080011994 default, the health checks won't go through socks tunnel even it was enabled
11995 for normal traffic.
11996
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011997ciphers <ciphers>
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020011998 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. This
11999 option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
12000 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000012001 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
12002 information and recommendations see e.g.
12003 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
12004 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
12005 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012006
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020012007ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
12008 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
12009 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. This option sets the string
12010 describing the list of cipher algorithms that is negotiated during the TLS
12011 1.3 handshake with the server. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000012012 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section.
12013 For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers"
12014 keyword.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020012015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012016cookie <value>
12017 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
12018 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
12019 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
12020 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
12021 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
12022 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
12023 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
12024
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012025crl-file <crlfile>
12026 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12027 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
12028 to verify server's certificate.
12029
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020012030crt <cert>
12031 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
12032 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
12033 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
12034 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
12035 certificate request.
12036
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020012037disabled
12038 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
12039 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
12040 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
12041 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
12042 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012043 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020012044
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012045enabled
12046 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
12047 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
12048 default value.
12049 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
12050 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020012051
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012052error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010012053 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
12054 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
12055 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012056
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012057 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012058
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012059fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012060 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
12061 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
12062 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
12063
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012064force-sslv3
12065 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
12066 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012067 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012068 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012069
12070force-tlsv10
12071 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012072 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012073 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012074
12075force-tlsv11
12076 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012077 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012078 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012079
12080force-tlsv12
12081 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012082 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012083 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012084
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012085force-tlsv13
12086 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
12087 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012088 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012089
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012090id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020012091 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
12092 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
12093 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012094
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010012095init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
12096 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
12097 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012098 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010012099 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
12100 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
12101 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
12102 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
12103 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
12104 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
12105 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
12106 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
12107 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012108 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010012109 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
12110 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
12111 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
12112 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
12113 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
12114 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012115 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010012116
12117 Example:
12118 defaults
12119 # never fail on address resolution
12120 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
12121
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012122inter <delay>
12123fastinter <delay>
12124downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012125 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
12126 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
12127 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
12128 between checks depending on the server state :
12129
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020012130 Server state | Interval used
12131 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
12132 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
12133 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
12134 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
12135 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
12136 or yet unchecked. |
12137 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
12138 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
12139 | "inter" otherwise.
12140 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012141
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012142 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
12143 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
12144 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
12145 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012146 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
12147 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
12148 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
12149 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
12150 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012151
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012152maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012153 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
12154 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
12155 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
12156 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
12157 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
12158 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
12159 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
12160 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
12161
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012162maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012163 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
12164 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
12165 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
12166 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
12167 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
12168 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
12169 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
12170
Willy Tarreau9c538e02019-01-23 10:21:49 +010012171max-reuse <count>
12172 The "max-reuse" argument indicates the HTTP connection processors that they
12173 should not reuse a server connection more than this number of times to send
12174 new requests. Permitted values are -1 (the default), which disables this
12175 limit, or any positive value. Value zero will effectively disable keep-alive.
12176 This is only used to work around certain server bugs which cause them to leak
12177 resources over time. The argument is not necessarily respected by the lower
12178 layers as there might be technical limitations making it impossible to
12179 enforce. At least HTTP/2 connections to servers will respect it.
12180
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012181minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012182 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
12183 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
12184 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
12185 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
12186 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
12187 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012188 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012189 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012190
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020012191namespace <name>
12192 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
12193 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
12194 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
12195 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
12196
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012197no-agent-check
12198 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
12199 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12200 default value.
12201 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12202 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
12203
12204no-backup
12205 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
12206 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12207 default value.
12208 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12209 "default-server" "backup" setting.
12210
12211no-check
12212 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
12213 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12214 default value.
12215 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12216 "default-server" "check" setting.
12217
12218no-check-ssl
12219 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
12220 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12221 default value.
12222 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12223 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
12224
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012225no-send-proxy
12226 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
12227 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12228 default value.
12229 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12230 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
12231
12232no-send-proxy-v2
12233 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
12234 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12235 default value.
12236 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12237 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
12238
12239no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
12240 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
12241 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12242 default value.
12243 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12244 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
12245
12246no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
12247 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
12248 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12249 default value.
12250 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12251 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
12252
12253no-ssl
12254 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
12255 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12256 default value.
12257 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12258 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
12259
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010012260no-ssl-reuse
12261 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
12262 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
12263 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
12264 and for paranoid users.
12265
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012266no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012267 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
12268 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012269 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012270
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012271 Supported in default-server: No
12272
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020012273no-tls-tickets
12274 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12275 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
12276 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012277 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
12278 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012279 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020012280
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012281no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012282 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012283 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12284 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012285 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12286 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012287 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012288
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012289 Supported in default-server: No
12290
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012291no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012292 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012293 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12294 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012295 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12296 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012297 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012298
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012299 Supported in default-server: No
12300
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012301no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012302 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012303 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12304 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012305 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12306 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012307 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012308
12309 Supported in default-server: No
12310
12311no-tlsv13
12312 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
12313 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12314 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
12315 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12316 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012317 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012318
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012319 Supported in default-server: No
12320
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012321no-verifyhost
12322 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
12323 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12324 default value.
12325 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12326 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012327
Frédéric Lécailleaeeb1c92019-07-04 14:19:06 +020012328no-tfo
12329 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "tfo"
12330 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12331 default value.
12332 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12333 "default-server" "tfo" setting.
12334
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090012335non-stick
12336 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
12337 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
12338 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
12339
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010012340npn <protocols>
12341 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
12342 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
12343 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012344 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010012345 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
12346 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
12347 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2.
12348
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012349observe <mode>
12350 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
12351 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
12352 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
12353 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
12354 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
12355 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010012356 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012357
12358 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
12359
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012360on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012361 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
12362 Currently, four modes are available:
12363 - fastinter: force fastinter
12364 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
12365 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
12366 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
12367 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
12368
12369 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
12370
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090012371on-marked-down <action>
12372 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
12373 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012374 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
12375 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
12376 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
12377 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
12378 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
12379 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
12380 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
12381 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090012382
12383 Actions are disabled by default
12384
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012385on-marked-up <action>
12386 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
12387 Currently one action is available:
12388 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
12389 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
12390 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
12391 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012392 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
12393 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012394 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
12395 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
12396
12397 Actions are disabled by default
12398
Olivier Houchard006e3102018-12-10 18:30:32 +010012399pool-max-conn <max>
12400 Set the maximum number of idling connections for a server. -1 means unlimited
12401 connections, 0 means no idle connections. The default is -1. When idle
12402 connections are enabled, orphaned idle connections which do not belong to any
12403 client session anymore are moved to a dedicated pool so that they remain
12404 usable by future clients. This only applies to connections that can be shared
12405 according to the same principles as those applying to "http-reuse".
12406
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010012407pool-purge-delay <delay>
12408 Sets the delay to start purging idle connections. Each <delay> interval, half
Olivier Houcharda56eebf2019-03-19 16:44:02 +010012409 of the idle connections are closed. 0 means we don't keep any idle connection.
Willy Tarreaufb553652019-06-04 14:06:31 +020012410 The default is 5s.
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010012411
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012412port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012413 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
12414 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
12415 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
12416 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
12417 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
12418 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
12419
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020012420proto <name>
12421
12422 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
12423 server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
12424 must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
12425 reported in haproxy -vv.
12426 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
12427 protocol for all connections established to this server.
12428
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012429redir <prefix>
12430 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
12431 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
12432 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
12433 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
12434 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
12435 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
12436 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
12437 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012438 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012439 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012440 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
12441 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
12442 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
12443 loop between the client and HAProxy!
12444
12445 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
12446
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012447rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012448 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
12449 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
12450 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
12451
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020012452resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
12453 Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
12454 server.
12455
12456 Available options:
12457
12458 * allow-dup-ip
12459 By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
12460 resolution at runtime is in operation.
12461 That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
12462 backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
12463 For such case, simply enable this option.
12464 This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
12465
12466 * prevent-dup-ip
12467 Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
12468 an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
12469 same fqdn.
12470 This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
12471
12472 Example:
12473 backend b_myapp
12474 default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
12475 server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
12476 server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
12477
12478 With the option allow-dup-ip set:
12479 * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
12480 it
12481 * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
12482 different address
12483
12484 Default value: not set
12485
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012486resolve-prefer <family>
12487 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
12488 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
12489 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
12490 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
12491
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020012492 Default value: ipv6
12493
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012494 Example:
12495
12496 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012497
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012498resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012499 This option prioritizes the choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012500 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010012501 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012502 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
12503 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012504 configured network, another address is selected.
12505
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012506 Example:
12507
12508 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012509
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012510resolvers <id>
12511 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
12512 hostname.
12513
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012514 Example:
12515
12516 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012517
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012518 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012519
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010012520send-proxy
12521 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
12522 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
12523 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
12524 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010012525 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
12526 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
12527 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
12528 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
12529 fully be chained to another instance of haproxy listening with an
12530 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
12531 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
12532 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
12533 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
12534 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012535 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
12536 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010012537
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012538send-proxy-v2
12539 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
12540 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12541 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12542 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020012543 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
12544 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
12545 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
12546 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012547
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010012548proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
12549 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add option to send in PROXY protocol version
12550 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are "ssl" (see also
Emmanuel Hocdetfa8d0f12018-02-01 15:53:52 +010012551 send-proxy-v2-ssl), "cert-cn" (see also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"), "ssl-cipher":
12552 name of the used cipher, "cert-sig": signature algorithm of the used
Emmanuel Hocdet253c3b72018-02-01 18:29:59 +010012553 certificate, "cert-key": key algorithm of the used certificate), "authority":
12554 host name value passed by the client (only sni from a tls connection is
Emmanuel Hocdet4399c752018-02-05 15:26:43 +010012555 supported), "crc32c": checksum of the proxy protocol v2 header.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010012556
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012557send-proxy-v2-ssl
12558 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
12559 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12560 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12561 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
12562 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
12563 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
12564 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012565 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
12566 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012567
12568send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
12569 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
12570 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12571 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12572 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
12573 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
12574 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
12575 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
12576 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012577 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
12578 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012579
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012580slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012581 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
12582 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
12583 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
12584 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
12585 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
12586 parameters :
12587
12588 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
12589 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
12590
12591 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
12592 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
12593 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
12594 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
12595
12596 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
12597 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
12598 seen as failed.
12599
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020012600sni <expression>
12601 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
12602 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
12603 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
12604 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020012605 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense. If
12606 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012607 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
Jérôme Magninb36a6d22018-12-09 16:03:40 +010012608 "verify" directive for more details. If you want to set a SNI for health
12609 checks, see the "check-sni" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020012610
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012611source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020012612source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012613source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012614 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
12615 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
12616 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
12617 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
12618
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012619 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
12620 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
12621 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
12622 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
12623 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
12624 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
12625 server.
12626
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000012627 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
12628 specifying the source address without port(s).
12629
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012630ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020012631 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
12632 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
12633 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
12634 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
12635 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
12636 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012637 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
12638 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012639
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012640ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
12641 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
12642 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
12643 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
12644
12645ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
12646 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
12647 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
12648 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
12649
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012650ssl-reuse
12651 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
12652 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12653 default value.
12654 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12655 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
12656
12657stick
12658 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
12659 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12660 default value.
12661 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12662 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012663
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080012664socks4 <addr>:<port>
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012665 This option enables upstream socks4 tunnel for outgoing connections to the
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080012666 server. Using this option won't force the health check to go via socks4 by
12667 default. You will have to use the keyword "check-via-socks4" to enable it.
12668
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020012669tcp-ut <delay>
12670 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
12671 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows haproxy to
12672 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012673 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020012674 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
12675 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
12676 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
12677 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
12678 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
12679 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
12680 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
12681 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
12682 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
12683
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010012684tfo
12685 This option enables using TCP fast open when connecting to servers, on
12686 systems that support it (currently only the Linux kernel >= 4.11).
12687 See the "tfo" bind option for more information about TCP fast open.
12688 Please note that when using tfo, you should also use the "conn-failure",
12689 "empty-response" and "response-timeout" keywords for "retry-on", or haproxy
Frédéric Lécailleaeeb1c92019-07-04 14:19:06 +020012690 won't be able to retry the connection on failure. See also "no-tfo".
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010012691
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012692track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020012693 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
12694 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
12695 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
12696 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012697 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
12698
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012699tls-tickets
12700 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
12701 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12702 default value.
12703 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12704 "default-server" "no-tlsv-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012705
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012706verify [none|required]
12707 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010012708 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012709 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
12710 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012711 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012712 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
12713 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
12714 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
12715 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
12716 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
12717 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
12718 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
12719 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012720
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070012721verifyhost <hostname>
12722 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012723 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
12724 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
12725 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
12726 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
12727 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
12728 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
12729 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
12730 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070012731
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012732weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012733 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
12734 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
12735 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020012736 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
12737 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
12738 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
12739 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
12740 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
12741 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012742
12743
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200127445.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
12745-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012746
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012747HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
12748using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
12749configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process' life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012750This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
12751can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
12752workload.
12753This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
12754resolution at run time.
12755Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
12756carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
12757
12758
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200127595.3.1. Global overview
12760----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012761
12762As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
12763different steps of the process life:
12764
12765 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
12766 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
12767 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
12768
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012769 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
12770 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012771
12772A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
12773 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
12774 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
12775 resolution to know this new IP.
12776
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012777When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012778HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012779SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
12780from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
12781will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, haproxy
12782will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020012783
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012784A few things important to notice:
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012785 - all the name servers are queried in the meantime. HAProxy will process the
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012786 first valid response.
12787
12788 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
12789 servers return an error.
12790
12791
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200127925.3.2. The resolvers section
12793----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012794
12795This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012796HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
12797contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012798
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012799When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
12800uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
12801is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
12802answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
12803
12804When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012805used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012806
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012807 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
12808 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
12809 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012810
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012811 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
12812 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012813
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012814 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retires> times. If no valid
12815 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
12816 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012817
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012818For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
12819following scenarios are possible:
12820
12821 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
12822 ignored
12823
12824 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
12825 applied
12826
12827 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
12828 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
12829
12830 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
12831 retries the query with a new type
12832
12833 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
12834 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012835
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012836As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, haproxy keeps
12837a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012838<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012839
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012840
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012841resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012842 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012843
12844A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
12845
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020012846accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012847 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012848 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020012849 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
12850 by RFC 6891)
12851
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020012852 Note: the maximum allowed value is 8192.
12853
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012854nameserver <id> <ip>:<port>
12855 DNS server description:
12856 <id> : label of the server, should be unique
12857 <ip> : IP address of the server
12858 <port> : port where the DNS service actually runs
12859
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060012860parse-resolv-conf
12861 Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
12862 list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
12863 placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
12864
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012865hold <status> <period>
12866 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
12867 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010012868 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012869 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid", "obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012870 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
12871 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
12872 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
12873
Baptiste Assmann686408b2017-08-18 10:15:42 +020012874 Default value is 10s for "valid", 0s for "obsolete" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012875
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012876resolve_retries <nb>
12877 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
12878 giving up.
12879 Default value: 3
12880
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012881 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
12882 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
12883 type.
12884
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012885timeout <event> <time>
12886 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
12887 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
12888 events available are:
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010012889 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
12890 other time applied.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012891 Default value: 1s
12892 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010012893 have been received.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012894 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012895 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
12896 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
12897
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012898 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012899
12900 resolvers mydns
12901 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
12902 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060012903 parse-resolv-conf
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012904 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012905 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012906 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010012907 hold other 30s
12908 hold refused 30s
12909 hold nx 30s
12910 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012911 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012912 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012913
12914
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200129156. HTTP header manipulation
12916---------------------------
12917
12918In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
12919response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
12920request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
12921which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010012922against information leak from the internal network.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012923
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010012924If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response" (status code 1xx), it is able
12925to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny, rewrite or delete a header,
12926but it will refuse to add a header to any such messages as this is not
12927HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers in such responses is to
12928stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may happen, for instance
12929because another downstream equipment would unconditionally add a header, or if
12930a server name appears there. When such messages are seen, normal processing
12931still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +020012932
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012933This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
12934in section 4.2 :
12935
12936 - reqadd <string>
12937 - reqallow <search>
12938 - reqiallow <search>
12939 - reqdel <search>
12940 - reqidel <search>
12941 - reqdeny <search>
12942 - reqideny <search>
12943 - reqpass <search>
12944 - reqipass <search>
12945 - reqrep <search> <replace>
12946 - reqirep <search> <replace>
12947 - reqtarpit <search>
12948 - reqitarpit <search>
12949 - rspadd <string>
12950 - rspdel <search>
12951 - rspidel <search>
12952 - rspdeny <search>
12953 - rspideny <search>
12954 - rsprep <search> <replace>
12955 - rspirep <search> <replace>
12956
12957With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
12958is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
12959parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
12960prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
12961Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
12962
12963 \t for a tab
12964 \r for a carriage return (CR)
12965 \n for a new line (LF)
12966 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
12967 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
12968 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
12969 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
12970 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
12971
12972The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
12973portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
12974above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
12975regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
129769 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
12977is very common to users of the "sed" program.
12978
12979The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
12980after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
12981
12982Notes related to these keywords :
12983---------------------------------
12984 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
12985 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
12986 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
12987
12988 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
12989 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
12990 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
12991
12992 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
12993 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
12994 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
12995 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
12996 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
12997
12998 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
12999 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
13000 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
13001 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
13002 useless headers before adding new ones.
13003
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013004 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013005 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
13006
13007 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
13008 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
13009 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
13010
13011 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
13012 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013013 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013014
13015
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200130167. Using ACLs and fetching samples
13017----------------------------------
13018
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013019HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013020client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
13021The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
13022these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
13023but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
13024data called patterns.
13025
13026
130277.1. ACL basics
13028---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013029
13030The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
13031content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
13032from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
13033simple :
13034
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013035 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013036 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013037 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
13038 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013039
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013040The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
13041adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013042
13043In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
13044
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013045 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013046
13047This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
13048Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
13049and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013050an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
13051conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
13052as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
13053are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013054
13055ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
13056'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
13057which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
13058
13059There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
13060performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
13061
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013062The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
13063specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
13064this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013065methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
13066ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013067
13068Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
13069 - boolean
13070 - integer (signed or unsigned)
13071 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
13072 - string
13073 - data block
13074
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013075Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
13076converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
13077would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
13078The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
13079which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
13080
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013081Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
13082keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
13083fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
13084which are summarized in the table below :
13085
13086 +---------------------+-----------------+
13087 | Sample or converter | Default |
13088 | output type | matching method |
13089 +---------------------+-----------------+
13090 | boolean | bool |
13091 +---------------------+-----------------+
13092 | integer | int |
13093 +---------------------+-----------------+
13094 | ip | ip |
13095 +---------------------+-----------------+
13096 | string | str |
13097 +---------------------+-----------------+
13098 | binary | none, use "-m" |
13099 +---------------------+-----------------+
13100
13101Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
13102matching method, see below.
13103
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013104The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
13105 - boolean
13106 - integer or integer range
13107 - IP address / network
13108 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
13109 - regular expression
13110 - hex block
13111
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013112The following ACL flags are currently supported :
13113
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013114 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
13115 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013116 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010013117 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010013118 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010013119 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013120 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
13121
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013122The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
13123read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
13124if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
13125lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
13126will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
13127beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
13128a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
13129lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
13130exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
13131
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010013132The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
13133parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
13134ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
13135a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
13136check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
13137
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010013138The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
13139socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
13140file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
13141
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013142Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
13143loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
13144
13145 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
13146
13147In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
13148the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
13149case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
13150as well.
13151
13152The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
13153sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
13154do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
13155methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
13156is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013157obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013158followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
13159default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
13160that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
13161string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
13162
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010013163The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
13164By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
13165string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
13166resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
13167server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013168waiting for the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010013169flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
13170function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
13171
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013172There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
13173sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
13174be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013175
13176 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
13177 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013178 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
13179 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
13180 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
13181 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013182
13183 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
13184 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013185 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013186
13187 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013188 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013189
13190 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013191 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013192
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013193 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013194 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
13195
13196 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
13197 binary or string samples.
13198
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013199 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
13200 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013201
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013202 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
13203 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
13204 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013205
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013206 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
13207 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013208
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013209 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
13210 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013211
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013212 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
13213 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013214
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013215 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
13216 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013217 This may be used with binary or string samples.
13218
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013219 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
13220 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
13221 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013222
13223For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
13224request, it is possible to do :
13225
13226 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
13227
13228In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
13229buffer, one would use the following acl :
13230
13231 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
13232
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013233On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
13234possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
13235
13236 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
13237
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013238All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
13239criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
13240method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
13241to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
13242criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
13243the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013244
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013245If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013246the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
13247For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013248
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013249 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
13250 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
13251 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
13252 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013253
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013254
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013255The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
13256types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
13257combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
13258brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
13259default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013260
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013261 +-------------------------------------------------+
13262 | Input sample type |
13263 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013264 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013265 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
13266 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
13267 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013268 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013269 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013270 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013271 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013272 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013273 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013274 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013275 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013276 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013277 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013278 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013279 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013280 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013281 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013282 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013283 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013284 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013285 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013286 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013287 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013288 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013289 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
13290 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
13291 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013292
13293
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200132947.1.1. Matching booleans
13295------------------------
13296
13297In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
13298Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
13299When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
13300that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
13301
13302Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
13303return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
13304"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
13305
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013306
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200133077.1.2. Matching integers
13308------------------------
13309
13310Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
13311enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
13312to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
13313
13314Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
13315matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
13316lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013317
13318For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
13319unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
13320representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
13321
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013322As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
13323two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
13324instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
13325ranges and operators.
13326
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013327For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013328operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
13329Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
13330of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013331
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013332Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013333
13334 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
13335 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
13336 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
13337 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
13338 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
13339
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013340For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013341
13342 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
13343
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013344This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
13345
13346 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
13347
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013348
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200133497.1.3. Matching strings
13350-----------------------
13351
13352String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
13353different forms :
13354
13355 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013356 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013357
13358 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013359 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013360
13361 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
13362 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
13363
13364 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
13365 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
13366
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010013367 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013368 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
13369 matches.
13370
13371 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
13372 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
13373 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013374
13375String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
13376exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
13377characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
13378string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
13379to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013380before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013381
13382
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200133837.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
13384---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013385
13386Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
13387they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
13388possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
13389passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
13390the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013391the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
13392match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013393
13394
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200133957.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
13396-------------------------------------
13397
13398It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
13399not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
13400a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
13401to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
13402digits may be used upper or lower case.
13403
13404Example :
13405 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
13406 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
13407
13408
134097.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
13410---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013411
13412IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
13413netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
13414within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010013415host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013416difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
13417at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
13418does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
13419parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013420
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020013421The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
13422abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
13423
13424 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
13425 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
13426 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
13427 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
13428 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
13429 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
13430 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
13431 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
13432
13433Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
13434192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
13435
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020013436IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
13437Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
13438trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
13439IPv6 patterns.
13440
13441HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
13442following situations :
13443 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
13444 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
13445 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
13446 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
13447 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
13448 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
13449 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
13450 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
13451 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
13452 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
13453
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013454
134557.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
13456----------------------------------
13457
13458Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
13459combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
13460
13461 - AND (implicit)
13462 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
13463 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013464
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013465A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013466
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013467 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020013468
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013469Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
13470indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020013471
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013472For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
13473"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
13474requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
13475is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
13476
13477 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013478 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
13479 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
13480 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013481
13482To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
13483and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
13484
13485 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
13486 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
13487 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
13488 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
13489
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013490 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013491 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
13492 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
13493 use_backend www if host_www
13494
13495It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
13496expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
13497be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
13498the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
13499
13500 The following rule :
13501
13502 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013503 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013504
13505 Can also be written that way :
13506
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013507 http-request deny if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013508
13509It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
13510to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
13511simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
13512sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
13513good use is the following :
13514
13515 With named ACLs :
13516
13517 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
13518 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
13519 monitor fail if site_dead
13520
13521 With anonymous ACLs :
13522
13523 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
13524
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013525See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
13526keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013527
13528
135297.3. Fetching samples
13530---------------------
13531
13532Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
13533against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
13534sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
13535ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
13536of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
13537available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
13538
13539This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
13540Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
13541compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
13542deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
13543
13544The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
13545matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
13546method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
13547indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
13548
13549As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
13550when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
13551mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
13552the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
13553ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
13554
13555Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
13556multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
13557when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013558incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
13559are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013560is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
13561all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
13562
13563Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
13564 - name
13565 - name(arg1)
13566 - name(arg1,arg2)
13567
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013568
135697.3.1. Converters
13570-----------------
13571
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013572Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
13573of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
13574is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
13575was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013576has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013577unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
13578
13579These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
13580sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
13581the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013582support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013583
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013584A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
13585support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
13586supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
13587(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
13588bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
13589
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013590The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013591
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001359251d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
13593 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
13594 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
13595 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
13596 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
13597 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
13598
13599 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013600 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
13601 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000013602 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
13603 frontend http-in
13604 bind *:8081
13605 default_backend servers
13606 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
13607 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
13608
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013609add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013610 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013611 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013612 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
13613 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013614 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013615 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13616 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13617 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13618 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013619 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013620 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013621
Nenad Merdanovicc31499d2019-03-23 11:00:32 +010013622aes_gcm_dec(<bits>,<nonce>,<key>,<aead_tag>)
13623 Decrypts the raw byte input using the AES128-GCM, AES192-GCM or
13624 AES256-GCM algorithm, depending on the <bits> parameter. All other parameters
13625 need to be base64 encoded and the returned result is in raw byte format.
13626 If the <aead_tag> validation fails, the converter doesn't return any data.
13627 The <nonce>, <key> and <aead_tag> can either be strings or variables. This
13628 converter requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.1.
13629
13630 Example:
13631 http-response set-header X-Decrypted-Text %[var(txn.enc),\
13632 aes_gcm_dec(128,txn.nonce,Zm9vb2Zvb29mb29wZm9vbw==,txn.aead_tag)]
13633
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013634and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013635 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013636 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013637 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
13638 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013639 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013640 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13641 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13642 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13643 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013644 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013645 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013646
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020013647b64dec
13648 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
13649 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
13650
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020013651base64
13652 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013653 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020013654 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
13655
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013656bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013657 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013658 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013659 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013660 presence of a flag).
13661
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010013662bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
13663 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
13664 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013665 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010013666
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010013667concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
13668 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
13669 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
13670 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
13671 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
13672 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
13673 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
13674 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
13675 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
13676 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
13677 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013678 other variables, such as colon-delimited values. Note that due to the config
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010013679 parser, it is not possible to use a comma nor a closing parenthesis as
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013680 delimiters.
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010013681
13682 Example:
13683 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
13684 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
13685 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
13686 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
13687
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013688cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013689 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
13690 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013691
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010013692crc32([<avalanche>])
13693 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
13694 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13695 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13696 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13697 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13698 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
13699 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
13700 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
13701 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
13702 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013703 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
13704
13705crc32c([<avalanche>])
13706 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
13707 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13708 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13709 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
13710 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
13711 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
13712 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
13713 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010013714
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010013715da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013716 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
13717 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
13718 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
13719 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000013720 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the haproxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013721 configuration language.
13722
13723 Example:
13724 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020013725 bind *:8881
13726 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000013727 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013728
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020013729debug
13730 This converter is used as debug tool. It dumps on screen the content and the
13731 type of the input sample. The sample is returned as is on its output. This
13732 converter only exists when haproxy was built with debugging enabled.
13733
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013734div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013735 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
13736 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013737 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013738 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
13739 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013740 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013741 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13742 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13743 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13744 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013745 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013746 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013747
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013748djb2([<avalanche>])
13749 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
13750 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13751 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13752 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13753 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13754 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
13755 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013756 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
13757 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013758
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013759even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013760 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013761 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
13762
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020013763field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
13764 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
13765 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
13766 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
13767 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
13768 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
13769 fields.
13770
13771 Example :
13772 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
13773 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
13774 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
13775 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
13776 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010013777
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013778hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013779 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013780 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013781 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013782 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010013783
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020013784hex2i
13785 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013786 integer. If the input value cannot be converted, then zero is returned.
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020013787
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013788http_date([<offset>])
13789 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
13790 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
13791 an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added to
13792 the date before the conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to
13793 emit Date header fields, Expires values in responses when combined with a
13794 positive offset, or Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013795
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013796in_table(<table>)
13797 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13798 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
13799 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013800 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013801 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
13802
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010013803ipmask(<mask4>, [<mask6>])
13804 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013805 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010013806 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
13807 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
13808 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
13809 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
13810 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013811
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013812json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013813 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013814 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020013815 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013816 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
13817 of errors:
13818 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
13819 bytes, ...)
13820 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
13821 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
13822
13823 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
13824 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
13825 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
13826 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
13827 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
13828 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013829 - "ascii" : never fails;
13830 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
13831 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013832 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013833 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013834 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
13835 characters corresponding to the other errors.
13836
13837 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013838 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013839
13840 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013841 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020013842 capture request header user-agent len 150
13843 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013844
13845 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
13846 GET / HTTP/1.0
13847 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
13848
13849 Output log:
13850 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
13851
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013852language(<value>[,<default>])
13853 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
13854 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
13855 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
13856 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
13857 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
13858 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
13859 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
13860 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
13861 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013862 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013863 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
13864 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013865
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013866 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013867
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013868 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
13869 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013870
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013871 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
13872 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
13873 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
13874 use_backend spanish if es
13875 use_backend french if fr
13876 use_backend english if en
13877 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013878
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010013879length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010013880 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
13881 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
13882 type. The result is of type integer.
13883
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013884lower
13885 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
13886 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
13887 type. The result is of type string.
13888
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020013889ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
13890 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
13891 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
13892 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
13893 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
13894 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
13895 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
13896
13897 Example :
13898
13899 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013900 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020013901 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
13902
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013903map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
13904map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
13905map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
13906 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
13907 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
13908 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
13909 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
13910 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
13911 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
13912 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
13913 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013914
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013915 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
13916 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
13917 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013918
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013919 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013920 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013921
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013922 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
13923 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13924 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
13925 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020013926 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
13927 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013928 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
13929 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13930 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
13931 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13932 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
13933 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13934 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
13935 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080013936 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
13937 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13938 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013939 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13940 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
13941 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13942 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
13943 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013944
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010013945 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
13946 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
13947 the corresponding match text.
13948
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013949 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
13950 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
13951 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
13952 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
13953 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013954
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013955 Example :
13956
13957 # this is a comment and is ignored
13958 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
13959 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
13960 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
13961 | | | `---------- value
13962 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
13963 | `---------------------------- key
13964 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
13965
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013966mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013967 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
13968 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013969 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013970 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013971 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013972 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13973 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13974 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13975 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013976 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013977 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013978
13979mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013980 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020013981 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
13982 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013983 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013984 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013985 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013986 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13987 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13988 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13989 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013990 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013991 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013992
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010013993nbsrv
13994 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
13995 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
13996 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
13997 map lookup.
13998
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013999neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014000 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
14001 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
14002 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
14003 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014004
14005not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014006 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014007 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014008 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014009 absence of a flag).
14010
14011odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014012 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014013 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
14014
14015or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014016 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014017 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014018 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
14019 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014020 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014021 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14022 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
14023 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
14024 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014025 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014026 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014027
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010014028protobuf(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
14029 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
14030 sample representation of a protocol buffer message with <field_number> as field
14031 number (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample
14032 if this field is present (see also "ungrpc" below).
14033 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
14034 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
14035 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
14036 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
14037 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
14038 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
14039 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
14040
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010014041regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010014042 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
14043 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
14044 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
14045 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
14046 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
14047 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
14048 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
14049 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
14050 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
14051 It is important to note that due to the current limitations of the
Baptiste Assmann66025d82016-03-06 23:36:48 +010014052 configuration parser, some characters such as closing parenthesis, closing
14053 square brackets or comma are not possible to use in the arguments. The first
14054 use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence of
14055 characters with other ones.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010014056
14057 Example :
14058
14059 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
14060 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
14061 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
14062 http-request set-header x-path %[hdr(x-path),regsub(/+,/,g)]
14063
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020014064capture-req(<id>)
14065 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
14066 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
14067
14068 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020014069 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
14070 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020014071
14072capture-res(<id>)
14073 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
14074 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
14075
14076 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020014077 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
14078 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020014079
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014080sdbm([<avalanche>])
14081 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
14082 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
14083 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
14084 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
14085 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
14086 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
14087 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010014088 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
14089 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014090
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014091set-var(<var name>)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014092 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
14093 as-is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of
14094 the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014095 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014096 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14097 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014098 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014099 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14100 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014101 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014102 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014103
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020014104sha1
14105 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA1 digest. The result is a binary
14106 sample with length of 20 bytes.
14107
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020014108strcmp(<var>)
14109 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
14110 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
14111 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
14112 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
14113 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
14114 shorter).
14115
14116 Example :
14117
14118 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
14119 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
14120 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
14121
14122
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014123sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014124 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
14125 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014126 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014127 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
14128 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014129 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014130 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14131 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014132 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014133 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14134 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014135 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014136 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014137
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014138table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
14139 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14140 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14141 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
14142 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
14143 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
14144 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
14145
14146
14147table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
14148 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14149 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14150 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
14151 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
14152 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
14153 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
14154
14155table_conn_cnt(<table>)
14156 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14157 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014158 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014159 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
14160 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
14161
14162table_conn_cur(<table>)
14163 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14164 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14165 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
14166 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
14167 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
14168
14169table_conn_rate(<table>)
14170 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14171 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14172 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
14173 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
14174 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
14175
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020014176table_gpt0(<table>)
14177 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14178 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
14179 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
14180 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
14181 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
14182
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014183table_gpc0(<table>)
14184 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14185 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14186 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
14187 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
14188 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
14189
14190table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
14191 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14192 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14193 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
14194 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
14195 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
14196 sample fetch keyword.
14197
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014198table_gpc1(<table>)
14199 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14200 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14201 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
14202 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
14203 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
14204
14205table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
14206 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14207 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14208 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
14209 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
14210 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
14211 sample fetch keyword.
14212
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014213table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
14214 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14215 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014216 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014217 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
14218 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
14219
14220table_http_err_rate(<table>)
14221 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14222 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14223 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
14224 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
14225 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
14226 keyword.
14227
14228table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
14229 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14230 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014231 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014232 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
14233 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
14234
14235table_http_req_rate(<table>)
14236 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14237 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14238 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
14239 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
14240 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
14241 keyword.
14242
14243table_kbytes_in(<table>)
14244 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14245 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014246 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014247 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
14248 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
14249 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
14250 keyword.
14251
14252table_kbytes_out(<table>)
14253 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14254 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014255 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014256 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
14257 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
14258 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
14259 keyword.
14260
14261table_server_id(<table>)
14262 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14263 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14264 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
14265 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
14266 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
14267 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
14268
14269table_sess_cnt(<table>)
14270 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14271 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014272 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014273 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
14274 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
14275 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
14276 keyword.
14277
14278table_sess_rate(<table>)
14279 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14280 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14281 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
14282 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
14283 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
14284 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
14285 keyword.
14286
14287table_trackers(<table>)
14288 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14289 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14290 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
14291 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
14292 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
14293 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
14294 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
14295 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
14296 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
14297 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
14298
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020014299upper
14300 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
14301 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
14302 type. The result is of type string.
14303
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020014304url_dec
14305 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded
14306 version as output. The input and the output are of type string.
14307
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014308ungrpc(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010014309 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010014310 sample representation of a gRPC message with <field_number> as field number
14311 (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample if this
14312 field is present.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014313 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
14314 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
14315 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
14316 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014317 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014318 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
14319 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010014320
14321 Example:
14322 // with such a protocol buffer .proto file content adapted from
14323 // https://github.com/grpc/grpc/blob/master/examples/protos/route_guide.proto
14324
14325 message Point {
14326 int32 latitude = 1;
14327 int32 longitude = 2;
14328 }
14329
14330 message PPoint {
14331 Point point = 59;
14332 }
14333
14334 message Rectangle {
14335 // One corner of the rectangle.
14336 PPoint lo = 48;
14337 // The other corner of the rectangle.
14338 PPoint hi = 49;
14339 }
14340
14341 let's say a body request is made of a "Rectangle" object value (two PPoint
14342 protocol buffers messages), the four protocol buffers fields could be
14343 extracted with these "ungrpc" directives:
14344
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014345 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
14346 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "lo" first PPoint
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014347 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "hi" second PPoint
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014348 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "hi" second PPoint
14349
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014350 We could also extract the intermediary 48.59 field as a binary sample as follows:
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014351
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014352 req.body,ungrpc(48.59)
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014353
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014354 As a gRPC message is always made of a gRPC header followed by protocol buffers
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010014355 messages, in the previous example the "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
14356 could be extracted with these equivalent directives:
14357
14358 req.body,ungrpc(48.59),protobuf(1,int32)
14359 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59.1,int32)
14360 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59),protobuf(1,int32)
14361
14362 Note that the first convert must be "ungrpc", the remaining ones must be
14363 "protobuf" and only the last one may have or not a second argument to
14364 interpret the previous binary sample.
14365
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010014366
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010014367unset-var(<var name>)
14368 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
14369 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
14370 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
14371 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14372 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
14373 response),
14374 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14375 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
14376 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
14377 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
14378
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020014379utime(<format>[,<offset>])
14380 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
14381 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
14382 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
14383 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
14384 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
14385 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
14386
14387 Example :
14388
14389 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014390 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020014391 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
14392
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020014393word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
14394 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
14395 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
14396 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
14397 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
14398 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
14399
14400 Example :
14401 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
14402 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
14403 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
14404 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
14405 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010014406
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014407wt6([<avalanche>])
14408 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
14409 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
14410 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
14411 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
14412 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
14413 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
14414 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010014415 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
14416 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014417
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014418xor(<value>)
14419 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014420 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014421 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014422 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014423 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014424 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14425 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014426 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014427 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14428 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014429 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014430 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014431
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010014432xxh32([<seed>])
14433 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
14434 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
14435 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
14436 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
14437 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
14438 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
14439 as cryptographically secure.
14440
14441xxh64([<seed>])
14442 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
14443 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
14444 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
14445 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
14446 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
14447 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
14448 as cryptographically secure.
14449
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014450
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200144517.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014452--------------------------------------------
14453
14454A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
14455not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
14456"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
14457The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
14458
14459always_false : boolean
14460 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
14461 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
14462
14463always_true : boolean
14464 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
14465 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
14466
14467avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014468 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014469 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
14470 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
14471 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
14472 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
14473 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
14474 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
14475 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
14476 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
14477 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
14478 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
14479 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
14480 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
14481 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010014482
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014483be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014484 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
14485 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
14486 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
14487 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040014488 See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
14489
14490be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
14491 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
14492 across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
14493 servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
14494 backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
14495 to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040014496 nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
14497 criteria.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040014498
14499 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
14500 (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
14501 case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014502
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014503be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
14504 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14505 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
14506 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014507 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014508 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
14509 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014510
14511 Example :
14512 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
14513 backend dynamic
14514 mode http
14515 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
14516 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014517
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014518bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014519 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
14520 of the string.
14521
14522bool(<bool>) : bool
14523 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
14524 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
14525
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014526connslots([<backend>]) : integer
14527 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014528 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014529 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
14530 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050014531
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014532 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014533 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014534 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
14535
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014536 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
14537 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014538
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014539 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014540 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014541 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014542 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014543 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014544 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014545 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014546
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014547 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
14548 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014549 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014550 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014551
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010014552cpu_calls : integer
14553 Returns the number of calls to the task processing the stream or current
14554 request since it was allocated. This number is reset for each new request on
14555 the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value should usually be
14556 low and stable (around 2 calls for a typically simple request) but may become
14557 high if some processing (compression, caching or analysis) is performed. This
14558 is purely for performance monitoring purposes.
14559
14560cpu_ns_avg : integer
14561 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
14562 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
14563 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
14564 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
14565 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
14566 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
14567 and may affect other connection's apparent response time. Certain operations
14568 like compression, complex regex matching or heavy Lua operations may directly
14569 affect this value, and having it in the logs will make it easier to spot the
14570 faulty processing that needs to be fixed to recover decent performance.
14571 Note: this value is exactly cpu_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
14572
14573cpu_ns_tot : integer
14574 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
14575 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
14576 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
14577 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
14578 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
14579 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
14580 induces CPU costs on the machine, and may affect other connection's apparent
14581 response time. Certain operations like compression, complex regex matching or
14582 heavy Lua operations may directly affect this value, and having it in the
14583 logs will make it easier to spot the faulty processing that needs to be fixed
14584 to recover decent performance. The value may be artificially high due to a
14585 high cpu_calls count, for example when processing many HTTP chunks, and for
14586 this reason it is often preferred to log cpu_ns_avg instead.
14587
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020014588date([<offset>]) : integer
14589 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
14590 If an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added
14591 to the current date before returning the value. This is particularly useful
14592 to compute relative dates, as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020014593 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
14594
14595 Example :
14596
14597 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
14598 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020014599
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010014600date_us : integer
14601 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
14602 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
14603 from the same timeval structure.
14604
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020014605distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
14606 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
14607 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
14608 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
14609 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
14610 haproxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
14611 list of supported tokens.
14612
14613distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
14614 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
14615 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
14616 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
14617 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
14618 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through haproxy.
14619 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
14620 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
14621 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
14622 supported tokens.
14623
14624 Example :
14625 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
14626 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
14627 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
14628 # send large files to the big farm
14629 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
14630
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020014631env(<name>) : string
14632 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
14633 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
14634 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
14635 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
14636 certain way.
14637
14638 Examples :
14639 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
14640 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
14641
14642 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
14643 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
14644
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014645fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
14646 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014647 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
14648 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014649 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
14650 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014651 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014652 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
14653 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014654
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020014655fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
14656 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
14657 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
14658 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
14659
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014660fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
14661 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14662 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
14663 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
14664 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
14665 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
14666 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
14667 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
14668 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010014669
14670 Example :
14671 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
14672 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
14673 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
14674 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
14675 frontend mail
14676 bind :25
14677 mode tcp
14678 maxconn 100
14679 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
14680 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
14681 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
14682 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014683
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010014684hostname : string
14685 Returns the system hostname.
14686
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014687int(<integer>) : signed integer
14688 Returns a signed integer.
14689
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014690ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
14691 Returns an ipv4.
14692
14693ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
14694 Returns an ipv6.
14695
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010014696lat_ns_avg : integer
14697 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
14698 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
14699 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
14700 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
14701 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
14702 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
14703 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
14704 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
14705 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
14706 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, or to look for
14707 other heavy requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"),
14708 whose processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers
14709 could be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex.
14710 Note: this value is exactly lat_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
14711
14712lat_ns_tot : integer
14713 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
14714 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
14715 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
14716 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
14717 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
14718 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
14719 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
14720 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
14721 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
14722 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, or to look for
14723 other heavy requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"),
14724 whose processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers
14725 could be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: while it
14726 may intuitively seem that the total latency adds to a transfer time, it is
14727 almost never true because while a task waits for the CPU, network buffers
14728 continue to fill up and the next call will process more at once. The value
14729 may be artificially high due to a high cpu_calls count, for example when
14730 processing many HTTP chunks, and for this reason it is often preferred to log
14731 lat_ns_avg instead, which is a more relevant performance indicator.
14732
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014733meth(<method>) : method
14734 Returns a method.
14735
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010014736nbproc : integer
14737 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
14738 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
14739 and debugging purposes.
14740
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014741nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
14742 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
14743 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
14744 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014745 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
14746 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
14747 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010014748
Patrick Hemmerfabb24f2018-08-13 14:07:57 -040014749prio_class : integer
14750 Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
14751 for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
14752 set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
14753
14754prio_offset : integer
14755 Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
14756 connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
14757 "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
14758 set-priority-offset".
14759
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010014760proc : integer
14761 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
14762 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
14763 debugging purposes.
14764
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014765queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014766 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
14767 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
14768 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014769 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
14770 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
14771 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
14772 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
14773 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
14774
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010014775rand([<range>]) : integer
14776 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
14777 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
14778 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
14779 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
14780 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
14781
Luca Schimweg77306662019-09-10 15:42:52 +020014782uuid([<version>]) : string
14783 Returns a UUID following the RFC4122 standard. If the version is not
14784 specified, a UUID version 4 (fully random) is returned.
14785 Currently, only version 4 is supported.
14786
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014787srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14788 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
14789 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
14790 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
14791 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
14792 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040014793 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
14794 "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
14795
14796srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14797 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
14798 on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
14799 The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
14800 server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
14801 farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
14802 number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
14803 "srv_conn" fetch methods.
14804
14805 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
14806 does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014807
14808srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
14809 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
14810 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
14811 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014812 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014813 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
14814 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
14815 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
14816
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020014817srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14818 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
14819 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
14820 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
14821 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
14822 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
14823 fetch methods.
14824
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014825srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14826 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14827 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014828 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014829 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
14830 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014831 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014832 overloading servers).
14833
14834 Example :
14835 # Redirect to a separate back
14836 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
14837 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
14838 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
14839
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010014840stopping : boolean
14841 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
14842 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
14843 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
14844
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014845str(<string>) : string
14846 Returns a string.
14847
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014848table_avl([<table>]) : integer
14849 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
14850 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
14851
14852table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14853 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
14854 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
14855 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
14856
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010014857thread : integer
14858 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
14859 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
14860 and debugging purposes.
14861
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014862var(<var-name>) : undefined
14863 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014864 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
14865 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014866 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014867 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14868 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014869 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014870 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14871 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014872 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014873 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014874
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200148757.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014876----------------------------------
14877
14878The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
14879closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
14880methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
14881sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
14882TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014883the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
14884counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020014885"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
14886used if MAX_SESS_STKCTR value does not exceed 3, otherwise the counter number
14887can be specified as the first integer argument when using the "sc_" prefix.
14888Starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). An optional
14889table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the currently
14890tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of the table
14891currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014892
Jérôme Magnin35e53a62019-01-16 14:38:37 +010014893bc_http_major : integer
Jérôme Magnin86577422018-12-07 09:03:11 +010014894 Returns the backend connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
14895 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
14896 encoding and not the version present in the request header.
14897
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014898be_id : integer
14899 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
14900 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
14901
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010014902be_name : string
14903 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
14904 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
14905
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014906dst : ip
14907 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
14908 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
14909 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
14910 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010014911 RFC 4291. When the incoming connection passed through address translation or
14912 redirection involving connection tracking, the original destination address
14913 before the redirection will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and
14914 destination may seldom appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl
14915 is set, because a late response may reopen a timed out connection and switch
14916 what is believed to be the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014917
14918dst_conn : integer
14919 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
14920 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
14921 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
14922 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
14923 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
14924 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
14925 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
14926 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014927
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020014928dst_is_local : boolean
14929 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
14930 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
14931 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
14932 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014933 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020014934 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
14935 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
14936 it only once per connection.
14937
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014938dst_port : integer
14939 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
14940 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
14941 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
14942 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
14943 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
14944 an HTTP header.
14945
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020014946fc_http_major : integer
14947 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
14948 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
14949 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
14950
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010014951fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
14952 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
14953 header.
14954
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020014955fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
14956 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
14957 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
14958 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
14959 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
14960 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
14961 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14962
14963fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
14964 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
14965 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
14966 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
14967 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
14968 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
14969 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14970
Christopher Faulet297df182019-10-17 14:40:48 +020014971fc_unacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070014972 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
14973 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
14974 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
14975 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14976
Christopher Faulet297df182019-10-17 14:40:48 +020014977fc_sacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070014978 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
14979 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
14980 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
14981 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14982
Christopher Faulet297df182019-10-17 14:40:48 +020014983fc_retrans : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070014984 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
14985 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14986 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14987 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14988
Christopher Faulet297df182019-10-17 14:40:48 +020014989fc_fackets : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070014990 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
14991 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14992 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14993 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14994
Christopher Faulet297df182019-10-17 14:40:48 +020014995fc_lost : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070014996 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
14997 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14998 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14999 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15000
Christopher Faulet297df182019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015001fc_reordering : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015002 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
15003 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
15004 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
15005 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15006
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020015007fe_defbe : string
15008 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
15009 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
15010
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015011fe_id : integer
15012 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010015013 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015014 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
15015
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010015016fe_name : string
15017 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
15018 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
15019 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
15020
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015021sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015022sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
15023sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
15024sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015025 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
15026 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
15027 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
15028
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015029sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015030sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
15031sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
15032sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015033 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
15034 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
15035 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
15036
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015037sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015038sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15039sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15040sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015041 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
15042 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010015043 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
15044 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
15045 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015046
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015047 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015048 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
15049 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015050 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
15051 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
15052 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015053 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
15054 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
15055
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015056sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15057sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15058sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15059sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15060 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
15061 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
15062 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
15063 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
15064 when a first ACL was verified.
15065
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015066sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015067sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15068sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15069sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015070 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015071 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
15072
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015073sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015074sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
15075sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
15076sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015077 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
15078 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
15079 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
15080
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015081sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015082sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
15083sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
15084sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015085 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
15086 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
15087 See also src_conn_rate.
15088
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015089sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015090sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15091sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15092sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015093 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015094 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015095
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015096sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15097sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15098sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15099sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15100 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
15101 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
15102
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020015103sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15104sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
15105sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
15106sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
15107 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
15108 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
15109
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015110sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015111sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
15112sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
15113sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015114 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
15115 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
15116 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015117 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
15118 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
15119 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015120
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015121sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15122sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
15123sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
15124sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
15125 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
15126 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
15127 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
15128 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
15129 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
15130 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
15131
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015132sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015133sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15134sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15135sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015136 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015137 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
15138 See also src_http_err_cnt.
15139
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015140sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015141sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
15142sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
15143sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015144 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
15145 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
15146 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
15147 src_http_err_rate.
15148
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015149sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015150sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15151sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15152sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015153 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015154 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
15155 src_http_req_cnt.
15156
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015157sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015158sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
15159sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
15160sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015161 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
15162 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
15163 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
15164 src_http_req_rate.
15165
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015166sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015167sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15168sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15169sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015170 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010015171 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
15172 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
15173 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
15174 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015175
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015176 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015177 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
15178 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015179 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
15180
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015181sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15182sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15183sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15184sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15185 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
15186 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
15187 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
15188 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
15189 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
15190
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015191sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015192sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
15193sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
15194sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015195 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
15196 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
15197 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015198
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015199sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015200sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
15201sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
15202sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015203 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
15204 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
15205 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015206
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015207sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015208sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15209sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15210sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015211 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015212 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
15213 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
15214 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040015215 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015216 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
15217
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015218sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015219sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
15220sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
15221sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015222 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
15223 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
15224 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
15225 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
15226 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040015227 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015228
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015229sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015230sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
15231sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
15232sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020015233 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
15234 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
15235 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
15236
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015237sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015238sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
15239sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
15240sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010015241 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
15242 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015243 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010015244 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
15245 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015246 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
15247 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
15248 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010015249
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015250so_id : integer
15251 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
15252 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
15253 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015254
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015255src : ip
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015256 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015257 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
15258 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
15259 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010015260 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
15261 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
15262 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010015263 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address. When the incoming
15264 connection passed through address translation or redirection involving
15265 connection tracking, the original destination address before the redirection
15266 will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and destination may seldom
15267 appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late
15268 response may reopen a timed out connection and switch what is believed to be
15269 the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015270
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015271 Example:
15272 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
15273 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
15274
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015275src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
15276 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
15277 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
15278 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015279 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015280
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015281src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
15282 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
15283 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015284 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015285 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015286
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015287src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15288 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15289 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15290 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
15291 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
15292 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
15293 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015294
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015295 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015296 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
15297 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
15298 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
15299 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010015300 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015301 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
15302 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
15303
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015304src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15305 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15306 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15307 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
15308 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
15309 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
15310 was verified.
15311
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015312src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015313 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015314 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015315 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015316 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015317
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015318src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015319 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015320 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
15321 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015322 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015323
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015324src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
15325 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
15326 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15327 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015328 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015329
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015330src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015331 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015332 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015333 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015334 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015335
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015336src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15337 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
15338 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
15339 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
15340 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
15341
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020015342src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
15343 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
15344 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
15345 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
15346 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
15347
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015348src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015349 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015350 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015351 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
15352 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015353 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
15354 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
15355 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015356
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015357src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
15358 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
15359 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
15360 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
15361 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
15362 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
15363 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
15364 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
15365
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015366src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015367 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015368 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015369 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015370 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015371 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015372
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015373src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
15374 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
15375 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15376 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
15377 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015378 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015379
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015380src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015381 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015382 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
15383 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015384 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015385
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015386src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
15387 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
15388 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
15389 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015390 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015391 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015392
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015393src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15394 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15395 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15396 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015397 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015398 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
15399 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015400
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015401 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015402 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010015403 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015404 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015405
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015406src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15407 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15408 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15409 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
15410 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
15411 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
15412 connection when a first ACL was verified.
15413
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020015414src_is_local : boolean
15415 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
15416 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
15417 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
15418 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015419 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020015420 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
15421 once per connection.
15422
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015423src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015424 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
15425 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
15426 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
15427 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
15428 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015429
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015430src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015431 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
15432 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15433 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
15434 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
15435 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015436
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015437src_port : integer
15438 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
15439 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
15440 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
15441 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010015442
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015443src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015444 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015445 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15446 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
15447 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015448 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015449
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015450src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
15451 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
15452 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15453 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
15454 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015455 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015456
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015457src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15458 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
15459 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
15460 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
15461 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
15462 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
15463 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
15464 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
15465 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015466
15467 Example :
15468 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
15469 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
15470 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
15471 listen ssh
15472 bind :22
15473 mode tcp
15474 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015475 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015476 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015477 server local 127.0.0.1:22
15478
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015479srv_id : integer
15480 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
15481 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
15482 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020015483
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200154847.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015485----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020015486
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015487The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
15488closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
15489when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
15490usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015491future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020015492
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001549351d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
15494 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
15495 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
15496 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
15497 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
15498 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
15499
15500 Example :
15501 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
15502 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
15503 # the request.
15504 frontend http-in
15505 bind *:8081
15506 default_backend servers
15507 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
15508 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
15509
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015510ssl_bc : boolean
15511 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
15512 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
15513 other a server with the "ssl" option.
15514
15515ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
15516 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
15517 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15518
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015519ssl_bc_alpn : string
15520 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
15521 outgoing connection made via a TLS transport layer.
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020015522 The result is a string containing the protocol name negotiated with the
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015523 server. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
15524 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
15525 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "server" line specifies a
15526 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to pick a protocol from this
15527 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
15528 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_bc_npn".
15529
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015530ssl_bc_cipher : string
15531 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
15532 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15533
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040015534ssl_bc_client_random : binary
15535 Returns the client random of the back connection when the incoming connection
15536 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
15537 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
15538
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010015539ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
15540 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15541 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
15542 session or a TLS ticket.
15543
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015544ssl_bc_npn : string
15545 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an outgoing connection
15546 made via a TLS transport layer. The result is a string containing the
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020015547 protocol name negotiated with the server . The SSL library must have been
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015548 built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that
15549 the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on the
15550 "server" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to
15551 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be used. Please note that
15552 the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
15553
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015554ssl_bc_protocol : string
15555 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
15556 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15557
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015558ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015559 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015560 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
15561 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015562
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040015563ssl_bc_server_random : binary
15564 Returns the server random of the back connection when the incoming connection
15565 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
15566 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
15567
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015568ssl_bc_session_id : binary
15569 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
15570 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
15571 if session was reused or not.
15572
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040015573ssl_bc_session_key : binary
15574 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
15575 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
15576 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
15577 BoringSSL.
15578
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015579ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
15580 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
15581 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15582
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015583ssl_c_ca_err : integer
15584 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15585 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
15586 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
15587 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
15588 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020015589
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015590ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
15591 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15592 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
15593 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
15594 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015595
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010015596ssl_c_der : binary
15597 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
15598 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15599 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
15600
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015601ssl_c_err : integer
15602 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15603 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
15604 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
15605 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
15606 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015607
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015608ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15609 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15610 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
15611 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15612 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15613 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15614 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15615 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15616 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015617
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015618ssl_c_key_alg : string
15619 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
15620 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15621 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015622
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015623ssl_c_notafter : string
15624 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
15625 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15626 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020015627
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015628ssl_c_notbefore : string
15629 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
15630 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15631 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010015632
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015633ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15634 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15635 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
15636 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15637 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15638 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15639 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15640 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15641 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010015642
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015643ssl_c_serial : binary
15644 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
15645 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15646 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015647
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015648ssl_c_sha1 : binary
15649 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
15650 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
15651 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020015652 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
15653 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
15654
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015655 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020015656 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015657
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015658ssl_c_sig_alg : string
15659 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
15660 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15661 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015662
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015663ssl_c_used : boolean
15664 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
15665 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015666
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015667ssl_c_verify : integer
15668 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
15669 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
15670 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
15671 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015672
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015673ssl_c_version : integer
15674 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
15675 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015676
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010015677ssl_f_der : binary
15678 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
15679 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15680 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
15681
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015682ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15683 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15684 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
15685 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15686 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015687 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015688 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15689 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15690 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015691
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015692ssl_f_key_alg : string
15693 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
15694 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
15695 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015696
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015697ssl_f_notafter : string
15698 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
15699 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15700 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015701
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015702ssl_f_notbefore : string
15703 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
15704 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15705 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015706
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015707ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15708 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15709 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
15710 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15711 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15712 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15713 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15714 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15715 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015716
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015717ssl_f_serial : binary
15718 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
15719 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15720 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015721
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020015722ssl_f_sha1 : binary
15723 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
15724 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
15725 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
15726
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015727ssl_f_sig_alg : string
15728 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
15729 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15730 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015731
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015732ssl_f_version : integer
15733 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
15734 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15735
15736ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015737 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
15738 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
15739 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
15740
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015741 Example :
15742 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
15743 listen http-https
15744 bind :80
15745 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
15746 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
15747
15748ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
15749 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
15750 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15751
15752ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015753 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015754 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
15755 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
15756 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
15757 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
15758 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
15759 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
15760 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
15761 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
15762
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015763ssl_fc_cipher : string
15764 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
15765 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020015766
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015767ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin : binary
15768 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum returned
15769 value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010015770 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015771
15772ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex : string
15773 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
15774 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010015775 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015776
15777ssl_fc_cipherlist_str : string
15778 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
15779 number of ciphers returned is according with the value of
15780 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size". Note that this sample-fetch is only
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015781 available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the function is not enabled, this
Emmanuel Hocdetddcde192017-09-01 17:32:08 +020015782 sample-fetch returns the hash like "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015783
15784ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
15785 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can be return only is the value
15786 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010015787 take in account all the data of the cipher list.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015788
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040015789ssl_fc_client_random : binary
15790 Returns the client random of the front connection when the incoming connection
15791 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
15792 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
15793
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015794ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015795 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
15796 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010015797 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
15798 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
15799 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
15800 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015801
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020015802ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
15803 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
15804 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
15805 wait until the handshake happened.
15806
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015807ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
15808 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020015809 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
15810 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015811 that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020015812 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020015813
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020015814ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020015815 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010015816 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
15817 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020015818
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015819ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015820 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015821 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
15822 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
15823 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
15824 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
15825 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
15826 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
15827 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020015828
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015829ssl_fc_protocol : string
15830 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
15831 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020015832
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015833ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040015834 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015835 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
15836 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040015837
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040015838ssl_fc_server_random : binary
15839 Returns the server random of the front connection when the incoming connection
15840 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
15841 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
15842
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015843ssl_fc_session_id : binary
15844 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
15845 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
15846 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
15847 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020015848
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040015849ssl_fc_session_key : binary
15850 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
15851 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
15852 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
15853 BoringSSL.
15854
15855
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015856ssl_fc_sni : string
15857 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
15858 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
15859 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
15860 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
15861 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
15862
15863 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
15864 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
15865 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015866 requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020015867 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015868
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015869 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015870 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
15871 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020015872
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015873ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
15874 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
15875 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020015876
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020015877
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200158787.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015879------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020015880
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015881Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
15882sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
15883only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
15884For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
15885be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
15886can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
15887sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
15888for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
15889content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015890
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015891payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015892 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015893 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
15894 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015895
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015896payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
15897 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015898 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015899 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015900
Thierry FOURNIERd7d88812017-04-19 15:15:14 +020015901req.hdrs : string
15902 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
15903 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
15904 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
15905 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
15906
Thierry FOURNIER5617dce2017-04-09 05:38:19 +020015907req.hdrs_bin : binary
15908 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
15909 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
15910 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
15911 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
15912 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
15913 names and values (length of 0 for both).
15914
15915 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
15916
15917 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
15918 str: <int:length><bytes>
15919
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015920req.len : integer
15921req_len : integer (deprecated)
15922 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
15923 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
15924 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
15925 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
15926 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
15927 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
15928 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
15929 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015930
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015931req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
15932 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020015933 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
15934 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
15935 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
15936 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015937
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015938 ACL alternatives :
15939 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015940
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015941req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
15942 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
15943 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
15944 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
15945 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015946
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015947 ACL alternatives :
15948 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015949
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015950 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015951
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015952req.proto_http : boolean
15953req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
15954 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
15955 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
15956 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
15957 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
15958 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
15959 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
15960 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015961
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015962 Example:
15963 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
15964 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
15965 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015966 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015967
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015968req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
15969rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
15970 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
15971 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
15972 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
15973 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
15974 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
15975 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
15976 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015977
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015978 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
15979 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
15980 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
15981 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
15982 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
15983 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015984
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015985 ACL derivatives :
15986 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015987
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015988 Example :
15989 listen tse-farm
15990 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
15991 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
15992 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
15993 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
15994 # apply RDP cookie persistence
15995 persist rdp-cookie
15996 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
15997 # This is only useful makes sense if
15998 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
15999 stick-table type string size 204800
16000 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
16001 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
16002 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016003
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016004 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
16005 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016006
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016007req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
16008rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
16009 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
16010 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
16011 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
16012 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016013
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016014 ACL derivatives :
16015 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016016
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110016017req.ssl_alpn : string
16018 Returns a string containing the values of the Application-Layer Protocol
16019 Negotiation (ALPN) TLS extension (RFC7301), sent by the client within the SSL
16020 ClientHello message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the
16021 request buffer and not to the contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so
16022 this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This is useful
16023 in ACL to make a routing decision based upon the ALPN preferences of a TLS
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020016024 client, like in the example below. See also "ssl_fc_alpn".
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110016025
16026 Examples :
16027 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
16028 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
16029 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020016030 use_backend bk_acme if { req.ssl_alpn acme-tls/1 }
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110016031 default_backend bk_default
16032
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020016033req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
16034 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
16035 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020016036 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
16037 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
16038 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
16039 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
16040 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020016041
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016042req.ssl_hello_type : integer
16043req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
16044 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
16045 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
16046 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
16047 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
16048 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
16049 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
16050 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016051
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016052req.ssl_sni : string
16053req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
16054 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
16055 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
16056 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
16057 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
16058 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
16059 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
16060 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
16061 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
16062 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
16063 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
16064 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
16065 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016066
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016067 ACL derivatives :
16068 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016069
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016070 Examples :
16071 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
16072 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
16073 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
16074 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
16075 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016076
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053016077req.ssl_st_ext : integer
16078 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
16079 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
16080 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
16081 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
16082 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
16083 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
16084 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
16085 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
16086 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
16087
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016088req.ssl_ver : integer
16089req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
16090 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
16091 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
16092 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
16093 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
16094 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
16095 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
16096 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016097 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016098 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016099
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016100 ACL derivatives :
16101 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016102
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020016103res.len : integer
16104 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
16105 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
16106 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
16107 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
16108 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
16109 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
16110 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
16111 content inspection.
16112
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016113res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
16114 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020016115 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
16116 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
16117 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
16118 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016119
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016120res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
16121 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
16122 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
16123 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
16124 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016125
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016126 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016127
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020016128res.ssl_hello_type : integer
16129rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
16130 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
16131 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
16132 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
16133 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
16134 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
16135 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
16136 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
16137
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016138wait_end : boolean
16139 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
16140 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016141 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016142 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
16143 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016144 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016145 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
16146 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016147
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016148 Examples :
16149 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
16150 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
16151 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016152
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016153 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
16154 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
16155 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
16156 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
16157 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
16158 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
16159 tcp-request content reject
16160
16161
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200161627.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016163--------------------------------------
16164
16165It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
16166This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
16167data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
16168its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
16169HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
16170content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
16171to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
16172more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
16173response are indexed.
16174
16175base : string
16176 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
16177 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
16178 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
16179 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
16180 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
16181 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
16182 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
16183 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
16184
16185 ACL derivatives :
16186 base : exact string match
16187 base_beg : prefix match
16188 base_dir : subdir match
16189 base_dom : domain match
16190 base_end : suffix match
16191 base_len : length match
16192 base_reg : regex match
16193 base_sub : substring match
16194
16195base32 : integer
16196 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
16197 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
16198 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016199 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
16200 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
16201 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016202
16203base32+src : binary
16204 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
16205 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
16206 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
16207 per-URL counters.
16208
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010016209capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
16210 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
16211 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
16212 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
16213
16214capture.req.method : string
16215 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
16216 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
16217 because it's allocated.
16218
16219capture.req.uri : string
16220 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
16221 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
16222 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
16223 allocated.
16224
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020016225capture.req.ver : string
16226 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
16227 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
16228 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
16229
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010016230capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
16231 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
16232 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
16233 The first entry is an index of 0.
16234 See also: "capture response header"
16235
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020016236capture.res.ver : string
16237 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
16238 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
16239 persistent flag.
16240
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020016241req.body : binary
16242 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It
16243 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
16244 "option http-buffer-request". In case of chunked-encoded body, currently only
16245 the first chunk is analyzed.
16246
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020016247req.body_param([<name>) : string
16248 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
16249 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
16250 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
16251 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
16252 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
16253 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
16254 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
16255 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
16256 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
16257 given.
16258
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020016259req.body_len : integer
16260 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
16261 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
16262 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
16263 "option http-buffer-request".
16264
16265req.body_size : integer
16266 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
16267 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the first
16268 chunk in case of chunked encoding. In order to parse the chunks, it requires
16269 that the request body has been buffered made available using
16270 "option http-buffer-request".
16271
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016272req.cook([<name>]) : string
16273cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16274 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
16275 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
16276 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
16277 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
16278 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
16279 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
16280 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
16281 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
16282
16283 ACL derivatives :
16284 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
16285 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
16286 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
16287 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
16288 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
16289 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
16290 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
16291 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016292
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016293req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16294cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16295 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
16296 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016297
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016298req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
16299cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16300 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
16301 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
16302 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
16303 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020016304
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016305cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16306 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
16307 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
16308 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
16309 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020016310 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016311 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
16312 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
16313 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
16314 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016315
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016316hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16317 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
16318 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
16319 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
16320 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016321 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016322
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016323req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
16324 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
16325 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
16326 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
16327 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
16328 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
16329 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
16330 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
16331 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016332
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016333req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16334 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
16335 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
16336 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
16337 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016338
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016339req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16340 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
16341 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
16342 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
16343 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
16344 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
16345 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
16346 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
16347 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +000016348 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC7231 to know
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016349 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016350 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016351
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016352 ACL derivatives :
16353 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
16354 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
16355 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
16356 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
16357 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
16358 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
16359 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
16360 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
16361
16362req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16363hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
16364 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
16365 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
16366 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
16367 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
16368 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
16369 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
16370 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
16371 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
16372 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
16373
16374req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
16375hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
16376 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
16377 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
16378 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
16379 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
16380 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016381 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016382 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
16383 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
16384
16385req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
16386hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
16387 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
16388 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
16389 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
16390 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
16391 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
16392 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
16393 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
16394
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010016395
16396
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016397http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
16398 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
16399 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
16400 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
16401 basic auth is supported.
16402
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010016403http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
16404 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
16405 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
16406 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
16407 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016408 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
16409 basic auth is supported.
16410
16411 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010016412 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
16413 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
16414 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
16415 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016416
16417http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020016418 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
16419 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016420 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
16421 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020016422
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016423method : integer + string
16424 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
16425 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
16426 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
16427 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
16428 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
16429 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
16430 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016431
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016432 ACL derivatives :
16433 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016434
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016435 Example :
16436 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
16437 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
16438 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016439
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016440path : string
16441 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
16442 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
16443 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
16444 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
16445 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016446 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016447 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016448
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016449 ACL derivatives :
16450 path : exact string match
16451 path_beg : prefix match
16452 path_dir : subdir match
16453 path_dom : domain match
16454 path_end : suffix match
16455 path_len : length match
16456 path_reg : regex match
16457 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016458
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010016459query : string
16460 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
16461 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
16462 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
16463 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010016464 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010016465 which stops before the question mark.
16466
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010016467req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
16468 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
16469 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
16470 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
16471 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
16472
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016473req.ver : string
16474req_ver : string (deprecated)
16475 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
16476 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
16477 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016478
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016479 ACL derivatives :
16480 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020016481
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016482res.comp : boolean
16483 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
16484 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
16485 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016486
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016487res.comp_algo : string
16488 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
16489 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
16490 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016491
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016492res.cook([<name>]) : string
16493scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16494 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16495 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
16496 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020016497
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016498 ACL derivatives :
16499 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020016500
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016501res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16502scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16503 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
16504 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
16505 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016506
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016507res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
16508scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16509 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16510 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
16511 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016512
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016513res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16514 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
16515 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
16516 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
16517 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
16518 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
16519 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
16520 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
16521 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
16522 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016523
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016524res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16525 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
16526 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
16527 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
16528 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
16529 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016530
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016531res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16532shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
16533 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
16534 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
16535 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
16536 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
16537 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
16538 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
16539 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
16540 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016541
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016542 ACL derivatives :
16543 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
16544 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
16545 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
16546 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
16547 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
16548 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
16549 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
16550 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
16551
16552res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16553shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16554 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
16555 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
16556 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
16557 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
16558 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016559
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016560res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
16561shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
16562 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
16563 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
16564 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
16565 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
16566 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
16567 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016568
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010016569res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
16570 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
16571 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
16572 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
16573 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
16574
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016575res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
16576shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
16577 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
16578 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
16579 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
16580 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
16581 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
16582 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010016583
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016584res.ver : string
16585resp_ver : string (deprecated)
16586 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
16587 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020016588
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016589 ACL derivatives :
16590 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010016591
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016592set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16593 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16594 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020016595 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016596 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010016597
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016598 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
16599 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010016600
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016601status : integer
16602 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
16603 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
16604 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016605
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020016606unique-id : string
16607 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
16608 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
16609 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
16610 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
16611 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
16612 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
16613
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016614url : string
16615 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
16616 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
16617 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
16618 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
16619 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
16620 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
16621 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016622
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016623 ACL derivatives :
16624 url : exact string match
16625 url_beg : prefix match
16626 url_dir : subdir match
16627 url_dom : domain match
16628 url_end : suffix match
16629 url_len : length match
16630 url_reg : regex match
16631 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016632
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016633url_ip : ip
16634 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
16635 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
16636 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
16637 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
16638 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
16639 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
16640 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016641
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016642url_port : integer
16643 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
16644 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
16645 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
16646 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016647
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016648urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
16649url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016650 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
16651 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016652 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
16653 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
16654 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
16655 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016656 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
16657 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016658 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
16659 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016660
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016661 ACL derivatives :
16662 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
16663 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
16664 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
16665 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
16666 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
16667 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
16668 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
16669 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016670
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016671
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016672 Example :
16673 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
16674 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
16675 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
16676 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016677
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016678urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016679 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
16680 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
16681 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020016682
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020016683url32 : integer
16684 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
16685 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
16686 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
16687 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
16688 is an unsigned integer.
16689
16690url32+src : binary
16691 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
16692 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
16693 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
16694
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010016695
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200166967.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016697---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010016698
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016699Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
16700every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020016701order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010016702
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016703ACL name Equivalent to Usage
16704---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016705FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020016706HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016707HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
16708HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016709HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
16710HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
16711HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
16712HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
16713LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016714METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020016715METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016716METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
16717METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
16718METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
16719METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020016720METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016721METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020016722RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016723REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016724TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016725WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
16726---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010016727
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010016728
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200167298. Logging
16730----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010016731
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016732One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
16733provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
16734very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
16735provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
16736state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010016737to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016738headers.
16739
16740In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
16741about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
16742send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
16743
16744 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
16745 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
16746 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
16747 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
16748 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016749 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060016750 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016751
16752The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
16753allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
16754as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
16755while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
16756real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
16757delay.
16758
16759
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200167608.1. Log levels
16761---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016762
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090016763TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016764source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090016765HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
16766in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
16767track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
16768syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
16769about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016770
16771
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200167728.2. Log formats
16773----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016774
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016775HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090016776and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
16777slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
16778options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016779
16780 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
16781 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
16782 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
16783 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
16784 extents.
16785
16786 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
16787 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
16788 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
16789 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
16790 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
16791
16792 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
16793 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
16794 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
16795 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
16796 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
16797
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020016798 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
16799 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
16800 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
16801 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
16802
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016803 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
16804
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016805Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
16806specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
16807field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
16808servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
16809always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
16810identifier.
16811
16812Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
16813 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
16814 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
16815 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
16816 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
16817
16818
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200168198.2.1. Default log format
16820-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016821
16822This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
16823as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
16824format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
16825
16826 Example :
16827 listen www
16828 mode http
16829 log global
16830 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
16831
16832 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
16833 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
16834 (www/HTTP)
16835
16836 Field Format Extract from the example above
16837 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
16838 2 'Connect from' Connect from
16839 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
16840 4 'to' to
16841 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
16842 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
16843
16844Detailed fields description :
16845 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
16846 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
16847 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
16848 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
16849 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
16850 and processed the connection.
16851 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
16852
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016853In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
16854"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
16855connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
16856
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016857It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
16858will eventually disappear.
16859
16860
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200168618.2.2. TCP log format
16862---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016863
16864The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
16865is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
16866information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
16867counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
16868emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
16869environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
16870the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
16871sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020016872specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
16873not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
16874fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
16875marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016876
16877 Example :
16878 frontend fnt
16879 mode tcp
16880 option tcplog
16881 log global
16882 default_backend bck
16883
16884 backend bck
16885 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
16886
16887 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
16888 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
16889 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
16890
16891 Field Format Extract from the example above
16892 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
16893 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
16894 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
16895 4 frontend_name fnt
16896 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
16897 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
16898 7 bytes_read* 212
16899 8 termination_state --
16900 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
16901 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
16902
16903Detailed fields description :
16904 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016905 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
16906 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
16907 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016908 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016909 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016910 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016911
16912 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016913 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
16914 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
16915 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016916
16917 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
16918 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
16919 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016920 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
16921 HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
16922 connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
16923 HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016924
16925 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
16926 and processed the connection.
16927
16928 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
16929 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
16930 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
16931 applications.
16932
16933 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
16934 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
16935 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
16936 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
16937 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
16938
16939 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
16940 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
16941 See "Timers" below for more details.
16942
16943 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
16944 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
16945 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
16946 "Timers" below for more details.
16947
16948 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016949 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016950 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
16951 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
16952 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
16953 details.
16954
16955 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
16956 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
16957 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
16958 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
16959 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
16960
16961 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
16962 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
16963 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
16964 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
16965 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
16966 for more details.
16967
16968 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016969 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016970 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
16971 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
16972 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016973 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016974
16975 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
16976 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
16977 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
16978 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
16979 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
16980 caused by a denial of service attack.
16981
16982 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
16983 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
16984 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
16985 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
16986 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
16987 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
16988 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
16989 denial of service attack.
16990
16991 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
16992 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
16993 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
16994 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
16995 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
16996 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
16997 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
16998 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
16999 be processed than on other servers.
17000
17001 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
17002 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
17003 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
17004 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
17005 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
17006 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
17007 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
17008 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
17009 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
17010 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
17011 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
17012 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
17013 should not be attributed to the logged server.
17014
17015 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
17016 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
17017 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
17018 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
17019 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
17020 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017021 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017022 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
17023
17024 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
17025 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
17026 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
17027 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
17028 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
17029 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017030 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017031 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
17032 occurs.
17033
17034
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200170358.2.3. HTTP log format
17036----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017037
17038The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
17039is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
17040the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
17041are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
17042emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
17043generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
17044"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
17045which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017046frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
17047is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017048
17049Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
17050slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
17051with a star ('*') after the field name below.
17052
17053 Example :
17054 frontend http-in
17055 mode http
17056 option httplog
17057 log global
17058 default_backend bck
17059
17060 backend static
17061 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
17062
17063 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
17064 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
17065 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017066 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017067
17068 Field Format Extract from the example above
17069 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
17070 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017071 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017072 4 frontend_name http-in
17073 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017074 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017075 7 status_code 200
17076 8 bytes_read* 2750
17077 9 captured_request_cookie -
17078 10 captured_response_cookie -
17079 11 termination_state ----
17080 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
17081 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
17082 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
17083 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
17084 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017085
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017086Detailed fields description :
17087 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010017088 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
17089 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
17090 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010017091 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017092 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010017093 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017094
17095 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010017096 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
17097 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
17098 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017099
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017100 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
17101 was received by haproxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017102
17103 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
17104 and processed the connection.
17105
17106 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
17107 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
17108 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
17109
17110 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
17111 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
17112 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
17113 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
17114 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
17115 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
17116
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017117 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
17118 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
17119 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017120 request could be received or a bad request was received. It should
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017121 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
17122 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017123 haproxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
17124 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017125
17126 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
17127 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017128 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017129
17130 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
17131 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017132 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
17133 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017134
17135 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
17136 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
17137 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
17138 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
17139 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017140 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
17141 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017142
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017143 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in haproxy, which is the total
17144 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
17145 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
17146 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
17147 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
17148 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
17149 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017150 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017151
17152 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
17153 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
17154 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
17155
17156 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
17157 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017158 specified, this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017159 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
17160 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
17161 overflowing.
17162
17163 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
17164 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
17165 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
17166 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
17167 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
17168 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
17169 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
17170 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
17171
17172 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
17173 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
17174 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
17175 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
17176 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
17177 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
17178 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
17179 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
17180
17181 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
17182 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
17183 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
17184 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
17185 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
17186 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
17187 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
17188
17189 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017190 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017191 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
17192 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
17193 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017194 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017195 system.
17196
17197 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
17198 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
17199 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
17200 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
17201 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
17202 caused by a denial of service attack.
17203
17204 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
17205 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
17206 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
17207 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
17208 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
17209 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
17210 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
17211 denial of service attack.
17212
17213 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
17214 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
17215 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
17216 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
17217 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
17218 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
17219 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
17220 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
17221 processed than on other servers.
17222
17223 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
17224 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
17225 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
17226 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
17227 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
17228 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
17229 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
17230 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
17231 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
17232 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
17233 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
17234 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
17235 should not be attributed to the logged server.
17236
17237 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
17238 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
17239 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
17240 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
17241 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
17242 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017243 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017244 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
17245
17246 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
17247 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
17248 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
17249 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
17250 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
17251 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017252 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017253 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
17254 occurs.
17255
17256 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
17257 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
17258 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
17259 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
17260 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
17261 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
17262 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
17263 cookies" below for more details.
17264
17265 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
17266 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
17267 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
17268 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
17269 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
17270 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
17271 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
17272 and cookies" below for more details.
17273
17274 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
17275 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
17276 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
17277 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
17278 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
17279 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
17280 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
17281 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
17282
17283
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200172848.2.4. Custom log format
17285------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017286
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017287The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017288mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017289
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017290HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017291Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
17292separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
17293prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
17294
17295Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
17296variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010017297("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017298
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010017299If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020017300as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010017301less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
17302the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
17303
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017304Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017305In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceded by another '%' resulting
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010017306in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017307
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010017308Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
17309'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
17310https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
17311such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
17312
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017313Flags are :
17314 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017315 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010017316 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
17317 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017318
17319 Example:
17320
17321 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
17322 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
17323
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010017324 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
17325
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017326At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
17327
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017328 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
17329 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017330
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017331the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017332
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017333 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
17334 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
17335 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017336
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017337and the default TCP format is defined this way :
17338
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017339 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
17340 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017341
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017342Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
17343
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017344 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017345 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017346 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
17347 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
17348 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017349 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
17350 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
17351 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017352 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000017353 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
17354 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string (path) | string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000017355 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000017356 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
17357 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010017358 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020017359 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017360 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017361 | | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017362 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020017363 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080017364 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017365 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
17366 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
17367 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
17368 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
17369 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017370 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017371 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
17372 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017373 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017374 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
17375 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017376 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
17377 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
17378 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017379 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017380 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
17381 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017382 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017383 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
17384 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
17385 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020017386 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020017387 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020017388 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
17389 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
17390 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
17391 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020017392 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017393 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017394 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017395 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010017396 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017397 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017398 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
17399 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
17400 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017401 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017402 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
17403 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017404 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017405 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
17406 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
Jens Bissinger15c64ff2018-08-23 14:11:27 +020017407 | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017408 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017409 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017410 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017411
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017412 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017413
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010017414
174158.2.5. Error log format
17416-----------------------
17417
17418When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
17419protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
17420By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
17421"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017422will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010017423logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
17424
17425The format looks like this :
17426
17427 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
17428 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
17429 Connection error during SSL handshake
17430
17431 Field Format Extract from the example above
17432 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
17433 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
17434 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
17435 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
17436 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
17437
17438These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
17439failures.
17440
17441
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200174428.3. Advanced logging options
17443-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017444
17445Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
17446just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
17447options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
17448for more information about their usage.
17449
17450
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200174518.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
17452------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017453
17454It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
17455haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
17456commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
17457monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
17458ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
17459
17460 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
17461 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
17462 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
17463 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
17464
17465 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
17466 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
17467 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017468 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017469 such as other load-balancers.
17470
17471 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
17472 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
17473 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
17474
17475
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200174768.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
17477----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017478
17479The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
17480what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
17481or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017482"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017483just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
17484log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
17485after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
17486is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
17487with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
17488with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
17489
17490
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200174918.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
17492------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017493
17494Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
17495for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
17496"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
17497retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
17498raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
17499a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
17500file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
17501you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
17502"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
17503
17504
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200175058.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
17506--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017507
17508Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
17509multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
17510them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
17511"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
17512logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
17513error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
17514and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
17515too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
17516useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
17517alternative.
17518
17519
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200175208.4. Timing events
17521------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017522
17523Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
17524reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
17525the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
17526frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017527mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
17528addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
17529
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010017530Timings events in HTTP mode:
17531
17532 first request 2nd request
17533 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
17534 t tr t tr ...
17535 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
17536 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
17537 :<---- Tq ---->: :
17538 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
17539 :<--------- Ta --------->:
17540
17541Timings events in TCP mode:
17542
17543 TCP session
17544 |<----------------->|
17545 t t
17546 ---|----|----|----|----|---
17547 | Th Tw Tc Td |
17548 |<------ Tt ------->|
17549
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017550 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017551 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017552 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
17553 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
17554 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017555 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017556 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
17557 reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
17558 all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
17559 request will always report zero here.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017560
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017561 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
17562 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
17563 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017564 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
17565 multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
17566 after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
17567 server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
17568 pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
17569 value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017570
17571 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
17572 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
17573 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
17574 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
17575 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
17576 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
17577 request typed by hand during a test.
17578
17579 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
17580 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017581 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017582 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
17583 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
17584 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
17585 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017586
17587 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
17588 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
17589 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
17590 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
17591 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
17592
17593 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
17594 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
17595 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
17596 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
17597 connection never established.
17598
17599 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
17600 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
17601 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
17602 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
17603 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
17604 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
17605 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
17606 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
17607 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
17608 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
17609 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
17610
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017611 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
17612 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
17613 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
17614 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
17615 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
17616 by subtracting other timers when valid :
17617
17618 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
17619
17620 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
17621 "Ta" can never be negative.
17622
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017623 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
17624 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017625 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
17626 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017627 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017628
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017629 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017630
17631 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017632 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
17633 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017634
17635These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
17636protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
17637that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017638due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
17639"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
17640that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017641
17642Most common cases :
17643
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017644 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
17645 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
17646 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
17647 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
17648 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
17649 ended, haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
17650 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
17651 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
17652 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
17653 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
17654 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020017655 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017656
17657 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
17658 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
17659 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
17660 of ms on remote networks.
17661
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017662 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
17663 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
17664 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017665
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017666 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
17667 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
17668 haproxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
17669 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
17670 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
17671 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
17672 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
17673 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
17674 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017675
17676Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
17677
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017678 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017679 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017680 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017681
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017682 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017683 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
17684 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
17685
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017686 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017687 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
17688 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
17689 flags.
17690
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017691 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
17692 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017693 Check the session termination flags, then check the
17694 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
17695 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
17696 the client connection was maintained open.
17697
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017698 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017699 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017700 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017701 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
17702
17703
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200177048.5. Session state at disconnection
17705-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017706
17707TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
17708"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
177092-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
17710each of which has a special meaning :
17711
17712 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
17713 session to terminate :
17714
17715 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
17716
17717 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
17718 server explicitly refused it.
17719
17720 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
17721 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
17722 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
17723 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017724 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020017725
17726 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
17727 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017728
17729 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
17730 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
17731 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
17732 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
17733 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
17734
17735 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
17736 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
17737 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
17738 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
17739 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
17740
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090017741 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
17742 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
17743
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070017744 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
17745 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
17746 backup connections when going up.
17747
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020017748 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
17749
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017750 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
17751 send or receive data.
17752
17753 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
17754 send or receive data.
17755
17756 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
17757 with nothing left in the buffers.
17758
17759 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
17760
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010017761 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017762 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
17763
17764 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
17765 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
17766 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
17767 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
17768 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
17769
17770 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
17771 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
17772
17773 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
17774 server (HTTP only).
17775
17776 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
17777
17778 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
17779 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
17780 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
17781
17782 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
17783 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
17784 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
17785
17786 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
17787
17788 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
17789 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
17790
17791 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
17792 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
17793 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
17794
17795 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
17796 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020017797 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
17798 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017799
17800 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
17801 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
17802 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
17803 another server.
17804
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017805 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017806 server.
17807
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017808 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
17809 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
17810 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
17811 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
17812
17813 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
17814 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
17815 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
17816 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
17817
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020017818 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
17819 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
17820 "use-server" rule).
17821
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017822 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
17823
17824 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
17825 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
17826
17827 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
17828
17829 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
17830 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
17831 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
17832
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017833 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
17834 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017835 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017836 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
17837 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
17838
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017839 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
17840
17841 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
17842 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
17843
17844 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
17845
17846 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
17847
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017848The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
17849was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017850helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
17851starvation, attacks, etc...
17852
17853The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
17854alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
17855easier finding and understanding.
17856
17857 Flags Reason
17858
17859 -- Normal termination.
17860
17861 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
17862 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
17863 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
17864 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
17865
17866 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
17867 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
17868 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
17869 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
17870 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
17871 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017872
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017873 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
17874 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020017875 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017876
17877 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
17878 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
17879 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
17880
17881 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
17882 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
17883 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
17884 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
17885 the server takes too long to respond.
17886
17887 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
17888 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
17889 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
17890 long a time to respond.
17891
17892 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
17893 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
17894 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
17895 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020017896 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
17897 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017898
17899 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
17900 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
17901 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
17902 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
17903 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020017904 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020017905 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
17906 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
17907 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
17908 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
17909 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
17910 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
17911 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
17912 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017913 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020017914 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
17915 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
17916 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017917
17918 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
17919 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017920 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
17921 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
17922 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
17923 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017924
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020017925 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
17926 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
17927
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010017928 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017929 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
17930 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017931 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017932 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
17933 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
17934
17935 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
17936 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
17937 503 or 504 here.
17938
17939 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
17940 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
17941 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
17942 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
17943 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
17944
17945 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
17946 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017947 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017948 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
17949 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
17950
17951 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
17952 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
17953 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
17954 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
17955 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
17956 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
17957 between haproxy and the server.
17958
17959 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
17960 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
17961 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
17962 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
17963 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
17964 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
17965 solution is to fix the application.
17966
17967 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
17968 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
17969 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
17970 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
17971 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
17972 external attacks.
17973
17974 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
17975 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020017976 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017977 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
17978 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
17979
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010017980 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
17981 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
17982 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017983 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020017984 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010017985
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017986 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
17987 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
17988 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
17989 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010017990 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
17991 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
17992 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
17993 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
17994 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017995
17996 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
17997 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
17998 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
17999 returned an HTTP 403 error.
18000
18001 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
18002 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
18003 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
18004 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
18005
18006 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
18007 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
18008 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
18009 only be solved by proper system tuning.
18010
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018011The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
18012persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
18013important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
18014re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
18015
18016 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
18017
18018 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
18019 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
18020 set on a GET request.
18021
18022 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
18023 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040018024 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018025 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
18026
18027 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
18028 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
18029 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
18030
18031 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
18032 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
18033 already got a cookie.
18034
18035 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
18036 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
18037 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
18038 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
18039 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
18040
18041 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
18042 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
18043 new cookie was inserted in the response.
18044
18045 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
18046 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
18047 new cookie was inserted in the response.
18048
18049 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
18050 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
18051
18052 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
18053 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
18054 then advertised in the response.
18055
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018056
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200180578.6. Non-printable characters
18058-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018059
18060In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
18061consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
18062converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
18063prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
18064being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
18065escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
18066is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
18067'}' when logging headers.
18068
18069Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
18070issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
18071containing spaces is "User-Agent".
18072
18073Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
18074the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
18075performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
18076
18077
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200180788.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
18079---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018080
18081Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
18082achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018083section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018084cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
18085the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
18086the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018087locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018088not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
18089user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
18090a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
18091wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
18092
18093 Examples :
18094 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
18095 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
18096
18097 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
18098 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
18099
18100
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200181018.8. Capturing HTTP headers
18102---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018103
18104Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
18105proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
18106the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
18107server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
18108
18109Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
18110response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018111section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018112
18113It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010018114time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
18115appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018116are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
18117and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
18118follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
18119request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
18120in the logs.
18121
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020018122As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
18123frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
18124an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
18125
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018126 Example :
18127 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
18128 listen proxy-out
18129 mode http
18130 option httplog
18131 option logasap
18132 log global
18133 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
18134
18135 # log the name of the virtual server
18136 capture request header Host len 20
18137
18138 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
18139 capture request header Content-Length len 10
18140
18141 # log the beginning of the referrer
18142 capture request header Referer len 20
18143
18144 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
18145 capture response header Server len 20
18146
18147 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
18148 capture response header Content-Length len 10
18149
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018150 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018151 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
18152
18153 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
18154 capture response header Via len 20
18155
18156 # log the URL location during a redirection
18157 capture response header Location len 20
18158
18159 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
18160 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
18161 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
18162 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
18163 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
18164
18165 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
18166 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
18167 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
18168 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018169 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018170
18171 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
18172 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
18173 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
18174 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
18175 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018176 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018177
18178
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200181798.9. Examples of logs
18180---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018181
18182These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
18183them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
18184reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
18185
18186 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
18187 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
18188 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
18189
18190 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
18191 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
18192
18193 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
18194 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
18195 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
18196
18197 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
18198 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
18199
18200 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
18201 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
18202 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
18203
18204 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010018205 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018206 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
18207 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
18208
18209 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
18210 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
18211 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
18212
18213 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
18214 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020018215 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018216 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
18217 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
18218 to return the 502 and not the server.
18219
18220 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018221 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018222
18223 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
18224 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
18225 Nothing was sent to any server.
18226
18227 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
18228 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
18229
18230 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
18231 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018232 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018233 send a 408 return code to the client.
18234
18235 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
18236 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
18237
18238 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
18239 5 seconds ("c----").
18240
18241 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
18242 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018243 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018244
18245 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018246 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018247 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
18248 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
18249 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
18250 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
18251 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010018252
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020018253
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200182549. Supported filters
18255--------------------
18256
18257Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
18258accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
18259unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
18260
18261See also : "filter"
18262
182639.1. Trace
18264----------
18265
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010018266filter trace [name <name>] [random-parsing] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018267
18268 Arguments:
18269 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
18270 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
18271
18272 <random-parsing> enables the random parsing of data exchanged between
18273 the client and the server. By default, this filter
18274 parses all available data. With this parameter, it
18275 only parses a random amount of the available data.
18276
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018277 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018278 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
18279 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
18280 amount of the parsed data.
18281
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018282 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010018283
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018284This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
18285callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
18286information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
18287filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
18288
18289Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
18290tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
18291a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
18292
18293
182949.2. HTTP compression
18295---------------------
18296
18297filter compression
18298
18299The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
18300keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010018301when no other filter is used, it is enough. When used with the cache enabled,
18302it is also enough. In this case, the compression is always done after the
18303response is stored in the cache. But it is mandatory to explicitly use a filter
18304line to enable the HTTP compression when at least one filter other than the
18305cache is used for the same listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know
18306the filters evaluation order.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018307
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010018308See also : "compression" and section 9.4 about the cache filter.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018309
18310
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200183119.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
18312--------------------------------------------
18313
18314filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
18315
18316 Arguments :
18317
18318 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
18319 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
18320 parsed.
18321
18322 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
18323 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
18324 part must be placed in its own scope.
18325
18326The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
18327external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018328streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020018329exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
18330also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
18331
18332SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
18333the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
18334
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010018335For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020018336"doc/SPOE.txt".
18337
18338Important note:
18339 The SPOE filter is highly experimental for now and was not heavily
18340 tested. It is really not production ready. So use it carefully.
18341
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +0100183429.4. Cache
18343----------
18344
18345filter cache <name>
18346
18347 Arguments :
18348
18349 <name> is name of the cache section this filter will use.
18350
18351The cache uses a filter to store cacheable responses. The HTTP rules
18352"cache-store" and "cache-use" must be used to define how and when to use a
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050018353cache. By default the corresponding filter is implicitly defined. And when no
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010018354other filters than cache or compression are used, it is enough. In such case,
18355the compression filter is always evaluated after the cache filter. But it is
18356mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to use a cache when at least one
18357filter other than the compression is used for the same
18358listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
18359order.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010018360
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010018361See also : section 9.2 about the compression filter and section 10 about cache.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010018362
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01001836310. Cache
18364---------
18365
18366HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
18367(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
18368RAM.
18369
18370The cache is based on a memory which is shared between processes and threads,
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +010018371this memory is split in blocks of 1k.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018372
18373If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
18374independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
18375when we try to allocate a new one.
18376
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +010018377The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018378
18379It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
18380"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
18381for more details.
18382
18383When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
18384replaced by "<CACHE>".
18385
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001838610.1. Limitation
18387----------------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018388
18389The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
18390
18391- If the response is not a 200
18392- If the response contains a Vary header
Frédéric Lécaille5f8bea62018-10-23 10:09:19 +020018393- If the Content-Length + the headers size is greater than "max-object-size"
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018394- If the response is not cacheable
18395
18396- If the request is not a GET
18397- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
William Lallemand8a16fe02018-05-22 11:04:33 +020018398- If the request contains an Authorization header
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018399
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010018400Caution!: For HAProxy version prior to 1.9, due to the limitation of the
18401filters, it is not recommended to use the cache with other filters. Using them
18402can cause undefined behavior if they modify the response (compression for
18403example). For HAProxy 1.9 and greater, it is safe, for HTX proxies only (see
18404"option http-use-htx" for details).
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018405
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001840610.2. Setup
18407-----------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018408
18409To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
18410the corresponding http-request and response actions.
18411
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001841210.2.1. Cache section
18413---------------------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018414
18415cache <name>
18416 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
18417 size of cache is mandatory.
18418
18419total-max-size <megabytes>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018420 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
Frédéric Lécaillee3c83d82018-10-25 10:46:40 +020018421 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries. Its maximum value is 4095.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018422
Frédéric Lécaille5f8bea62018-10-23 10:09:19 +020018423max-object-size <bytes>
Frédéric Lécaillee3c83d82018-10-25 10:46:40 +020018424 Define the maximum size of the objects to be cached. Must not be greater than
18425 an half of "total-max-size". If not set, it equals to a 256th of the cache size.
18426 All objects with sizes larger than "max-object-size" will not be cached.
Frédéric Lécaille5f8bea62018-10-23 10:09:19 +020018427
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018428max-age <seconds>
18429 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set has the lowest
18430 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
18431 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
18432 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
18433 default.
18434
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001843510.2.2. Proxy section
18436---------------------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018437
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +020018438http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018439 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
18440 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
18441 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
18442 after this one.
18443
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +020018444http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018445 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
18446 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
18447 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
18448 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
18449
18450
18451Example:
18452
18453 backend bck1
18454 mode http
18455
18456 http-request cache-use foobar
18457 http-response cache-store foobar
18458 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
18459
18460 cache foobar
18461 total-max-size 4
18462 max-age 240
18463
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010018464/*
18465 * Local variables:
18466 * fill-column: 79
18467 * End:
18468 */